target: restructure dap support
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{imx_gpio}
599 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
686 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
687 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
688 --command | -c run <command>
689 @end verbatim
690
691 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
692 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
693 To specify one or more different
694 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
695
696 @example
697 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
698 @end example
699
700 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
701 @enumerate
702 @item the current directory,
703 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
704 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
705 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
706 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
707 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
708 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
709 @end enumerate
710 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
711
712 @quotation Note
713 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
714 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
715 @end quotation
716
717 @section Simple setup, no customization
718
719 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
720 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
721 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
722 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
723 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
724
725 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
726 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
727 the server with some variation of one of the following:
728
729 @example
730 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
731 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
732 @end example
733
734 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
735 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
736 If all goes well you'll see output something like
737
738 @example
739 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
740 For bug reports, read
741 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
742 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
743 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
744 @end example
745
746 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
747 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
748 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
749
750 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
751
752 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
753 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
754 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
755 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
756 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
757 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
758 ensure that this always succeeds.
759 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
760 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
761 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
762 and then shut down without acting as a server.
763
764 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
765 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
766 those channels.
767
768 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
769 the @option{-d} option.
770
771 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
772 @option{-c} command line switch.
773
774 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
775 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
776 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
777 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
778 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
779 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
780 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
781
782 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
783 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
784
785 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
786 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
787 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
788 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
789
790 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
791 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
792
793 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
794 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
795 and start the OpenOCD server.
796 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
797 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
798 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
799 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
800
801 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
802
803 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
804 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
805 and a USB cable on the other.
806 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
807 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
808
809 @enumerate
810 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
811 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
812 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
813 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
814 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
815 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
816 debugging host.
817
818 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
819 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
820 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
821 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
822 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
823
824 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
825 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
826 with 1.2 Volt boards.
827
828 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
829 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
830 ways to connect the cable.
831 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
832 Be sure it's firmly connected.
833
834 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
835 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
836 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
837 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
838 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
839 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
840 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
841 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
842
843 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
844 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
845 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
846 but are tedious to set up.
847 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
848 adapter signals to the right board pins.
849
850 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
851 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
852 you are using to run OpenOCD.
853 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
854
855 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
856 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
857 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
858 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
861 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
862 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
863
864 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
865 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
866 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
867 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
868
869 @end enumerate
870
871 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
872 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
873 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
874
875 @section Project Directory
876
877 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
878
879 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
880 single directory for your work with a given board.
881 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
882 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
883 files accessed through semihosting,
884 and for code you upload to the target board.
885 It is also the natural place to write files,
886 such as log files and data you download from the board.
887
888 @section Configuration Basics
889
890 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
891 a variety of ways you can mix them.
892 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
893
894 @itemize
895 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
896 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
897 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
898 @end itemize
899
900 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
901 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
902 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
903
904 @example
905 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
906
907 # GDB can also flash my flash!
908 gdb_memory_map enable
909 gdb_flash_program enable
910
911 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
912 @end example
913
914 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
915
916 @example
917 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
918 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
919 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
920 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
921 @end example
922
923 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
924 each supporting a different development task.
925 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
926 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
927
928 @quotation Important
929 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
930 problems with how it treats variables.
931 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
932 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
933 that can be tested in a later script.
934 @end quotation
935
936 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
937 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
938 to simplify your work.
939
940 @section User Config Files
941 @cindex config file, user
942 @cindex user config file
943 @cindex config file, overview
944
945 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
946 in one place.
947 One of the following will match your situation best:
948
949 @itemize
950 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
951 provided by someone else.
952 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
953 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
954 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
955 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
956 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
957 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
958
959 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
960 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
961
962 @enumerate
963 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
964 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
965 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
966 @end enumerate
967
968 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
969 The first is an interface config file.
970 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
971 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
972 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
973 meet your deadline:
974
975 @example
976 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
977 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
978 @end example
979
980 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
981 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
982 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
983 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
984
985 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
986 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
987 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
988 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
989 target and board
990 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
991 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
992
993 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
994 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
995 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
996 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
997
998 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
999 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1000 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1001 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1002 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1003
1004 @quotation Note
1005 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1006 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1007 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1008 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1009 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1010 @end quotation
1011
1012 @item
1013 You may may need to write some C code.
1014 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1015 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1016 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1017 a new chip architecture.
1018 @end itemize
1019
1020 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1021 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1022 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1023
1024 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1025 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1026 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1027 @itemize
1028
1029 @item
1030 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1031 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1032 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1033 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1034
1035 @item
1036 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1037 @cindex vector_catch
1038 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1039 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1040 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1041 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1042 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1043 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1044
1045 @item
1046 You might need to override some defaults.
1047 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1048 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1049
1050 @item
1051 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1052 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1053 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1054 @end itemize
1055
1056 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1057
1058 A few project-specific utility
1059 routines may well speed up your work.
1060 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1061
1062 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1063 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1064 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1065 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1066 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1067 may help:
1068
1069 @example
1070 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1071 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1072 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1073 # Leave the CPU halted.
1074 reset init
1075
1076 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1077 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1078
1079 # Start running.
1080 resume 0x20000000
1081 @}
1082 @end example
1083
1084 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1085 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1086 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1087 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1088 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1089
1090 @example
1091 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1092 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1093 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1094 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1095 reset init
1096
1097 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1098 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1099 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1101 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1102 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1103 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1104
1105 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1106 reset run
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1111 from NAND.
1112 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1113 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1114 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1115
1116 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1117 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1118
1119 @section Target Software Changes
1120
1121 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1122 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1123 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1124 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1125 handling issues like:
1126
1127 @itemize @bullet
1128
1129 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1130 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1131 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1132 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1133 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1134 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1135 your debug sessions.
1136
1137 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1138 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1139 That might however be your only option.
1140
1141 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1142 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1143 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1144 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1145 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1146 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1147 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1148 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1149 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1150 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1151 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1152 instead of the whole thing.
1153 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1154 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1155
1156 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1157 @cindex ARM semihosting
1158 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1159 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1160 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1161 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1162 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1163 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1164 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1165 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1166 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1167 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1168 NAND or SPI flash.
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1171 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1172 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1173 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1174 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1175
1176 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1177 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1178 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1179 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1180 registers which can be used to change various features including
1181 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1182 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1183 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1184 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1185 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1186
1187 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1188 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1189 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1190 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1191 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1192
1193 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1194 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1195 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1196 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1197 early code execution can be debugged
1198 or firmware can be replaced.
1199
1200 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1201 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1202 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1203 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1204 operations like writing to memory.)
1205
1206 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1207 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1208 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1209 various kinds of message.
1210 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1211
1212 @end itemize
1213
1214 @section Target Hardware Setup
1215
1216 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1217 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1218 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1219 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1220 working with.}
1221
1222 Common issues include:
1223
1224 @itemize @bullet
1225
1226 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1227 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1228 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1229 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1230 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1231 or one from a daughtercard).
1232 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1233 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1234
1235 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1236 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1237 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1238 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1239 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1240 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1241
1242 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1243 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1244 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1245 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1246 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1247
1248
1249 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1250 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1251 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1252 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1253 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1254 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1255 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1256
1257 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1258 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1259 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1260 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1261 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1262
1263 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1264 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1265 used to start booting.
1266
1267 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1268 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1269 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1270 multiple audio codec chips).
1271 This interacts with software
1272 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1273 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1274 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1275 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1276 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1277 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1278 audio or video codecs are used.
1279
1280 @end itemize
1281
1282 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1283 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1284 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1285 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1286 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1287 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1288 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1289 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1290 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1291 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1292
1293
1294 @node Config File Guidelines
1295 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1296
1297 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1298 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1299 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1300 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1301
1302 You should find the following directories under
1303 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1304 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1305 @itemize @bullet
1306 @item @file{interface} ...
1307 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1308 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1309 @item @file{board} ...
1310 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1311 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1312
1313 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1314 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1315 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1316 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1317 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1318 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1319 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1320 a CPU and an FPGA.
1321 @item @file{target} ...
1322 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1323 on a chip
1324 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1325 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1326 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1327 the target config file defines all of them.
1328 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1329 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1330 @end itemize
1331
1332 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1333 file may override features in any of the above files by
1334 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1335 commands specific to their situation.
1336
1337 @section Interface Config Files
1338
1339 The user config file
1340 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1341
1342 @example
1343 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1344 @end example
1345
1346 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1347 in use today with OpenOCD.
1348 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1349 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1350
1351 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1352 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1353 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1354 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1355 and need to provide a driver for it.
1356
1357 @section Board Config Files
1358 @cindex config file, board
1359 @cindex board config file
1360
1361 The user config file
1362 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1363
1364 @example
1365 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1366 @end example
1367
1368 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1369 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1370 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1371
1372 @enumerate
1373 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1374 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1375 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1376 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1377 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1378 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1379 @end enumerate
1380
1381 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1382 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1383 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1384 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1385
1386 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1387 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1388 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1389 configuration works.
1390
1391 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1392
1393 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1394 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1395 convention on how to use certain variables.
1396
1397 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1398 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1399 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1400 used at will within a target configuration file.
1401
1402 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1403 for a board with three chips:
1404
1405 @example
1406 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1407 set CHIPNAME network
1408 set ENDIAN big
1409 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1410 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1411 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1412 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1413
1414 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1415 set CHIPNAME video
1416 set ENDIAN little
1417 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1418 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1419 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1420 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1421
1422 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1423 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1424 unset ENDIAN
1425 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1426 @end example
1427
1428 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1429 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1430 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1431 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1432 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1433 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1434 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1435 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1436
1437 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1438 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1439 naming collisions.
1440
1441 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1442 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1443 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1444 up other clocks and peripherals.
1445
1446 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1447 @cindex variable names
1448
1449 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1450 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1451 one such chip (as shown above).
1452 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1453 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1454 to promote consistency and
1455 so that board files can override target defaults.
1456
1457 Inputs to target config files include:
1458
1459 @itemize @bullet
1460 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1461 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1462 tap identifier dotted names.
1463 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1464 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1465 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1466 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1467 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1468 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1469 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1470 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1471 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1472 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1473 @end itemize
1474
1475 Outputs from target config files include:
1476
1477 @itemize @bullet
1478 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1479 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1480 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1481 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1482 specific to that board and that target.
1483 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1484 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1485 @end itemize
1486
1487 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1488 @cindex event, reset-init
1489 @cindex reset-init handler
1490
1491 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1492 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1493 fully set up yet.
1494 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1495 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1496 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1497 handler is one of the most important.
1498
1499 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1500 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1501 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1502 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1503 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1504
1505 @quotation Note
1506 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1507 are included here.
1508 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1509 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1510 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1511 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1512 @end quotation
1513
1514 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1515 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1516 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1517 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1518 those as parameters.
1519 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1520 and disabling the watchdog.
1521 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1522 the next developer doing such work.
1523 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1524
1525 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1526 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1527 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1528 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1529
1530 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1531
1532 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1533 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1534 a low JTAG clock rate.
1535 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1536 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1537 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1538 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1539 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1540 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1541 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1542
1543 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1544 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1545 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1546 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1547 which might be less than that.
1548
1549 @quotation Warning
1550 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1551 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1552 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1553 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1554 @end quotation
1555
1556 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1557 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1558 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1559 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1560 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1561 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1562
1563 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1564 @subsection The init_board procedure
1565 @cindex init_board procedure
1566
1567 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1568 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1569 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1570 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1571 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1572 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1573 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1574 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1575 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1576 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1577 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1578 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1579
1580 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1581 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1582
1583 @example
1584 ### board_file.cfg ###
1585
1586 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1587 source [find target/target.cfg]
1588
1589 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1590 # enables fast on-board clock source
1591 # configures the chip to use it
1592 @}
1593
1594 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1595 proc init_board @{@} @{
1596 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1597
1598 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1599 adapter_khz 100
1600 @}
1601
1602 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1603 enable_fast_clock
1604 adapter_khz 10000
1605 @}
1606 @}
1607 @end example
1608
1609 @section Target Config Files
1610 @cindex config file, target
1611 @cindex target config file
1612
1613 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1614 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1615 more target config files like this:
1616
1617 @example
1618 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1619 @end example
1620
1621 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1622 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1623 In summary the target files should contain
1624
1625 @enumerate
1626 @item Set defaults
1627 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1628 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1629 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1630 @item On-Chip flash
1631 @end enumerate
1632
1633 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1634 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1635 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1636
1637 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1638 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1639 can talk to the chip.
1640 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1641 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1642 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1643 and other processing engines.
1644
1645 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1646
1647 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1648 letting board config files express environment-specific
1649 differences in how things should be set up.
1650
1651 @example
1652 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1653 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1654 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1655 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1658 @}
1659
1660 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1661 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1662 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1663 @} else @{
1664 set _ENDIAN little
1665 @}
1666
1667 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1668 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1669 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1670 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1671 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1674 @}
1675 @end example
1676 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1677
1678 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1679 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1680 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1681
1682 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1683 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1684 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1685
1686 @example
1687 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1688 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1689 @end example
1690
1691 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1692 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1693 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1694 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1695 for taps.
1696
1697 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1698 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1699 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1700 looks (in part) like this:
1701
1702 @example
1703 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1704 @end example
1705
1706 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1707 to source such a config file twice, with different
1708 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1709 it adds a different TAP each time.
1710
1711 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1712 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1713 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1714 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1715
1716 @example
1717 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1718 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1719 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1720 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1721 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1722 @end example
1723
1724 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1725 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1726
1727 @itemize
1728 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1729 plus a JRC to enable them
1730 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1731 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1732 is not currently used)
1733 @end itemize
1734
1735 @subsection Add CPU targets
1736
1737 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1738 GDB and other commands can use it.
1739 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1740 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1741 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1742 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1743
1744 @example
1745 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1746 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1747 @end example
1748
1749 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1750 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1751 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1752 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1753 a work area if you can.
1754 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1755
1756 @example
1757 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1758 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1759 @end example
1760
1761 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1762 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1763 @cindex SMP
1764 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1765
1766 @example
1767 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1769 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1770 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1771 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1772 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1773 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1774 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1775 @end example
1776 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1777 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1778 @itemize @bullet
1779 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1780 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1781 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1782 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1783 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1784 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1785 @end itemize
1786
1787 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1788 command have been implemented.
1789 @itemize @bullet
1790 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1791 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1792 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1793 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1794 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1795 following example.
1796 @end itemize
1797
1798 @example
1799 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1800 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1801 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1802 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1803 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1804 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1805 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1806 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1807 > resume
1808 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1809 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1810 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1811 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1812 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1813 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1814 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1815 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1816 @end example
1817
1818
1819 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1820
1821 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1822 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1823 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1824
1825 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1826 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1827 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1828 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1829 both signals.
1830
1831 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1832 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1833 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1834 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1835 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1836 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1837 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1838 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1839 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1840 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1841 not available.)
1842
1843 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1844 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1845 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1846 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1847 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1848 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1849 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1850 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1851
1852 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1853 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1854 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1855 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1856 slower clock than they will use later.
1857 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1858 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1859 than they will use later.
1860 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1861
1862 @quotation Important
1863 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1864 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1865 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1866 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1867 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1868 @end quotation
1869
1870 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1871 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1872 @cindex init_targets procedure
1873
1874 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1875 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1876 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1877 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1878 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1879 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1880 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1881 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1882 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1883
1884 @example
1885 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1886
1887 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1888 # basic initialization procedure ...
1889 @}
1890
1891 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1892 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1893 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1894 @}
1895
1896 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1897
1898 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1899
1900 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1901 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1902 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1903 @}
1904 @end example
1905
1906 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1907 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1908
1909 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1910
1911 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1912 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1913
1914 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1915 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1916 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1917
1918 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1919 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1920 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1921 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1922 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1923 events already assigned.
1924
1925 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1926
1927 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1928 special high speed download features - enable it.
1929
1930 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1931
1932 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1933 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1934 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1935 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1936 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1937 If you are using an external trace port,
1938 configure it in your board config file.
1939 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1940 configure it in your target config file.
1941
1942 @example
1943 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1944 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1945 @end example
1946
1947 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1948
1949 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1950
1951 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1952 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1953 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1954 the TARGET (chip) file.
1955
1956 Examples:
1957 @itemize @bullet
1958 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1959 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1960 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1961 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1962 @end itemize
1963
1964 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1965 @section Translating Configuration Files
1966 @cindex translation
1967 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1968 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1969 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1970 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1971 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1972 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1973
1974 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1975 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1976 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1977 convert other scripts later on.
1978
1979 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1980 replace job:
1981
1982 @example
1983 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1984 #
1985 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1986 #
1987 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1988 #
1989 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1990
1991 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1992 global TARGETNAME
1993
1994 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1995
1996 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1997 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1998 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1999 @}
2000 @end example
2001
2002
2003
2004 @node Server Configuration
2005 @chapter Server Configuration
2006 @cindex initialization
2007 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2008 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2009 supported.
2010
2011 @anchor{configurationstage}
2012 @section Configuration Stage
2013 @cindex configuration stage
2014 @cindex config command
2015
2016 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2017 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2018 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2019 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2020 inside startup scripts.
2021
2022 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2023 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2024 which may be issued interactively.
2025 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2026 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2027
2028 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2029 flash banks,
2030 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2031 and other basic setup.
2032 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2033 may access or activate TAPs.
2034 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2035 longer be issued.
2036
2037 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2038 @section Entering the Run Stage
2039
2040 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2041 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2042 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2043 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2044 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2045 You should see no errors at this point.
2046 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2047 commands you used to configure the server.
2048 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2049 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2050 on the scan chain.
2051
2052 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2053 become available.
2054 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2055 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2056 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2057 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2058 entry to the run stage.
2059
2060 @deffn {Config Command} init
2061 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2062 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2063 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2064 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2065 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2066 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2067
2068 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2069 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2070 configuration files and/or command line options.
2071
2072 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2073 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2074 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2075 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2076 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2077 @end deffn
2078
2079 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2080 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2081 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2082
2083 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2084 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2085 scan chain.
2086 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2087 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2088
2089 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2090 they return.
2091 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2092 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @anchor{tcpipports}
2096 @section TCP/IP Ports
2097 @cindex TCP port
2098 @cindex server
2099 @cindex port
2100 @cindex security
2101 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2102 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2103 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2104
2105 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2106 access using one or more of these ports.
2107 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2108 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2109 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2110
2111 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2112 @cindex GDB server
2113 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2114 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2115 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2116 the normal use cases.
2117
2118 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2119 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2120 disables the gdb server.
2121
2122 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2123 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2124
2125 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2126 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2127
2128 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2129 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2130 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2131
2132 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2133 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2134 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2135 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2136
2137 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2138 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2139 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2140
2141 @end deffn
2142
2143 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2144 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2145 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2146 output from the Tcl engine.
2147 Intended as a machine interface.
2148 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2149 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2150 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2151 @end deffn
2152
2153 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2154 Specify or query the
2155 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2156 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2157 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2158 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2159 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2160 @end deffn
2161
2162 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2163 @section GDB Configuration
2164 @cindex GDB
2165 @cindex GDB configuration
2166 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2167 The ones listed here are static and global.
2168 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2169 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2170
2171 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2172 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2173 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2174 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2175 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2176 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2177 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2181 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2182 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2183 vFlash packet is received.
2184 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2188 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2189 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2190 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2191 for flash programming to work.
2192 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2198 by GDB memory read packets.
2199 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2200 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2205 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2209 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2210
2211 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @anchor{eventpolling}
2215 @section Event Polling
2216
2217 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2218 where significant events can happen at any time.
2219 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2220 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2221 or to GDB.
2222
2223 Examples of such events include:
2224
2225 @itemize
2226 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2227 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2228 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2229 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2230 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2231 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2232 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2233 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2234 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2235 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2236 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2237 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2238 @end itemize
2239
2240 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2241 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2242 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2243 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2244 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2245
2246 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2247 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2248 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2249 to the various active targets.
2250 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2251 which is normally done in the background.
2252
2253 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2254 Poll the current target for its current state.
2255 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2256 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2257 specific information about the current state is printed.
2258 An optional parameter
2259 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2260
2261 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2262 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2263 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2264 @example
2265 > poll
2266 background polling: on
2267 target state: halted
2268 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2269 current mode: Supervisor
2270 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2271 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2272 >
2273 @end example
2274 @end deffn
2275
2276 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2277 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2278 @cindex config file, interface
2279 @cindex interface config file
2280
2281 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2282 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2283 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2284
2285 @quotation Note
2286 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2287 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2288 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2289 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2290 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2291 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2292 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2293 @end quotation
2294
2295 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2296 through commands in an interface configuration
2297 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2298 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2299
2300 @example
2301 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2302 @end example
2303
2304 These commands tell
2305 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2306 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2307
2308 @example
2309 # jlink interface
2310 interface jlink
2311 @end example
2312
2313 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2314
2315
2316 @section Interface Configuration
2317
2318 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2319 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2320 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2321
2322 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2323 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2324 target.
2325 @end deffn
2326
2327 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2328 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2329 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2330 @end deffn
2331 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2332 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2333 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2334 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2335 the hardware can support.
2336 @end deffn
2337
2338
2339
2340 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2341 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2342 @end deffn
2343
2344 @section Interface Drivers
2345
2346 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2347 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2348 available at run time.
2349
2350 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2351 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2352 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2353 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2354
2355 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2356 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2357 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2358 @end deffn
2359
2360 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2361 Displays status of RTCK option.
2362 Optionally sets that option first.
2363 @end deffn
2364 @end deffn
2365
2366 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2367 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2368 This has one driver-specific command:
2369
2370 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2371 Logs some status
2372 @end deffn
2373 @end deffn
2374
2375 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2376 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2377 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2378 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2379 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2380 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2384 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2387 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2388 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2389 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2390 @example
2391 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2392 @end example
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2396 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2397 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2401 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2402 @end deffn
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2406 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2410 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2411 @end deffn
2412
2413 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2414 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2415 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2416
2417 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2418 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2419
2420 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added competely through
2421 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2422
2423 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2424 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2425 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2426 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2427 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2428 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2429
2430 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2431 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2432 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2433 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2434 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2435
2436 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2437 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2438 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2439 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2440
2441 @itemize @minus
2442 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2443 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2444 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2445 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2446 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2447 switching data and direction as necessary
2448 @end itemize
2449
2450 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2451 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2454 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2455 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2456 @example
2457 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2458 @end example
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2462 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2463 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2464 during device selection.
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2468 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2469 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2470 is connected to the host.
2471 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2472 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2473 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2477 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2478 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2479 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2480 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2481 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2482
2483 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2484 @end deffn
2485
2486 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2487 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2488 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2489 @end deffn
2490
2491 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2492 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2493 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2494 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2495 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2496 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2497 and initially asserted reset signals.
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2501 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2502 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2503 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2504 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2505 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2506 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2507 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2508 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2509 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2510 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2511
2512 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2513 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2514 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2515 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2516 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2517 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2518
2519 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2520 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2521 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2522 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2523 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2524 are always driven by the FTDI.
2525
2526 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2527 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2528 @var{name}.
2529 @end deffn
2530
2531 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2532 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2533 @itemize @minus
2534 @item @option{0}, drive low
2535 @item @option{1}, drive high
2536 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2537 @end itemize
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2541 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2542 @end deffn
2543
2544 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2545 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2546
2547 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2548 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2549 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2550 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2551 @itemize @minus
2552 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2553 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2554 @end itemize
2555 @end deffn
2556
2557 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2558 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2559
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2563 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R
2564 USB UART bridge IC.
2565
2566 List of connections (pin numbers for SSOP):
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2569 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2570 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2571 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2572 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2573 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2574 @end itemize
2575
2576 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2577 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2578
2579 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2580 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2581 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2585 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2586 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2587 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2588 @end deffn
2589
2590 @end deffn
2591
2592 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2593 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2594 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2595 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2596
2597 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2598 processors which are being simulated.
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2601 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2602 sockets instead of TCP.
2603 @end deffn
2604
2605 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2606 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2607 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2608 @end deffn
2609
2610 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2611 something like:
2612
2613 @example
2614 interface remote_bitbang
2615 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2616 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2617 @end example
2618
2619 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2620 named mysocket:
2621
2622 @example
2623 interface remote_bitbang
2624 remote_bitbang_port 0
2625 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2626 @end example
2627 @end deffn
2628
2629 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2630 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2631 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2632 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2633
2634 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2635 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2636 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2637 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2638 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2642 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2643 default values are used.
2644 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2645 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2646 @example
2647 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2648 @end example
2649 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2650 @example
2651 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2652 @end example
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2656 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2657 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2658 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2659 target board.
2660
2661 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2662 @example
2663 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2664 reset_config srst_only
2665 @end example
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2669 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2670 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2671 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2675 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2676 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2682 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2683 This has one driver-specific command:
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2686 Display either the address of the I/O port
2687 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2688 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2689 This is a write-once setting.
2690 @end deffn
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2694 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2695 transports.
2696
2697 @quotation Compatibility Note
2698 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2699 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2700 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2701 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2702 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2703 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2704 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2705 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2706 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2707 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2708 @end quotation
2709
2710 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2711 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2712 states.
2713 @end deffn
2714 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2715 Display free device internal memory.
2716 @end deffn
2717 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2718 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2719 command version.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2722 Display the device configuration.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2725 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2726 power state.
2727 @end deffn
2728 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2729 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2730 @end deffn
2731 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2732 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2733 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2734 IP configuration.
2735 @end deffn
2736 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2737 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2738 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2741 Reset the current configuration.
2742 @end deffn
2743 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2744 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2747 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2748 pairs.
2749
2750 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2751 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2752 @example
2753 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2754 @end example
2755 @end deffn
2756 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2757 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2758 pairs.
2759
2760 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2761 @example
2762 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2763 77a90000
2764 @end example
2765 @end deffn
2766 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2767 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2768 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2769 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2770 instead.
2771
2772 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2773 @end deffn
2774 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2775 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2776 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2777
2778 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2783 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2784 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2785 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2786 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2787 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2788 configuration script.
2789
2790 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2791 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2792 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2793 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2794 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2795
2796 Known limitations:
2797 @itemize @bullet
2798 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2799 and 2.7 MHz.
2800 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2801 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2802 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2803 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2804 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2805 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2806 communications with the target.
2807 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2808 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2809 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2810 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2811 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2812 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2813 @end itemize
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2816 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2817 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2818 @end deffn
2819
2820 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2821 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2822 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2823 @end deffn
2824
2825 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2826 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2827 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2828 target as a side-effect.
2829 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2833 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2834 version, and target voltage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @end deffn
2837
2838 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2839 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2840 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2841 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2842 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2843
2844 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2845 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2846 This is a write-once setting.
2847 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2848
2849 @itemize @minus
2850 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2851 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2852 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2853 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2854 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2855 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2856 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2857 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2858 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2859 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2860 some versions of
2861 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2862 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2863 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2864 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2865 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2866 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2867 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2868 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2869 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2870 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2871 @end itemize
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2875 Display either the address of the I/O port
2876 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2877 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2878 This is a write-once setting.
2879
2880 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2881 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2882 you may encounter a problem.
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2886 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2887 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2888 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2889 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2890 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2891
2892 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2893 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2894 @quotation Tip
2895 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2896 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2897 @example
2898 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2899 > adapter_khz 500
2900 @end example
2901 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2902 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2903 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2904 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2905 large set of samples.
2906 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2907 @example
2908 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2909 @end example
2910 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2911 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2912
2913 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2914 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2915 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2916 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2917 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2918 @end quotation
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2922 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2923 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2927 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2928
2929 @example
2930 interface parport
2931 parport_port 0x278
2932 parport_cable wiggler
2933 @end example
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2937 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2939 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2944 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2948 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2952 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2953
2954 @quotation Note
2955 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2956 which are not currently documented here.
2957 @end quotation
2958 @end deffn
2959
2960 @anchor{hla_interface}
2961 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2962 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2963 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2964 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2965
2966 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2967 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2968 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2969 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2970 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2971
2972 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2973 Currently Not Supported.
2974 @end deffn
2975
2976 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2977 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2978 @end deffn
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2981 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2982 @end deffn
2983
2984 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2985 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
2986 @end deffn
2987
2988 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2989 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2990 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2991 @end deffn
2992 @end deffn
2993
2994 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2995 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2996 @end deffn
2997
2998 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2999 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3000 @end deffn
3001
3002 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3003 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 @quotation Note
3007 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3008 which are not currently documented here.
3009 @end quotation
3010
3011 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3012 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3013 No arguments: print status.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3017 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3018 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3019
3020 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3021 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3022 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3023 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3024 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3025 configuration on exit.
3026
3027 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3028 pinout.
3029
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3033 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3034 of the one which is most popular.
3035
3036 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3037
3038 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3039 pinout.
3040
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3045 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3046 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3047
3048 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3049 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3050 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3051
3052 @itemize @minus
3053 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3054 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3055 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3056 @end itemize
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3060 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3061 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3062 @end deffn
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @section Transport Configuration
3066 @cindex Transport
3067 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3068 and the debug adapter you are using,
3069 several transports may be available to
3070 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3071 @deffn Command {transport list}
3072 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3073 version of OpenOCD.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3077 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3078
3079 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3080 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3081 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3082 adapter's driver).
3083
3084 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3085 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3086 supported by the debug adapter.
3087
3088 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3089 transport, if any.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @subsection JTAG Transport
3093 @cindex JTAG
3094 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3095 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3096 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3097 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3098 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3099 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3100
3101 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3102 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3103 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3104 hla_jtag}.
3105
3106 @subsection SWD Transport
3107 @cindex SWD
3108 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3109 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3110 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3111 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3112 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3113 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3114 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3115
3116 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3117 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3118 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3119 hla_swd}.
3120
3121 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3122 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3123 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3124 expected to change.
3125 @end deffn
3126 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3127 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3128 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3129 No parameters: displays current settings.
3130 @end deffn
3131
3132 @subsection SPI Transport
3133 @cindex SPI
3134 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3135 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3136 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3137 solution for flash programming.
3138
3139 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3140 @section JTAG Speed
3141 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3142 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3143 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3144 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3145 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3146 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3147 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3148 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3149 power management software that may be active.
3150
3151 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3152 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3153 target event handler.
3154 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3155 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3156 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3157 sets up those clocks).
3158 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3159 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3160 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3161 in the target config file.
3162 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3163 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3164 config file instead.
3165 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3166 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3167 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3168
3169 @example
3170 jtag_rclk 3000
3171 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3172 @end example
3173
3174 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3175 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3176 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3177 may not be the fastest solution.
3178
3179 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3180 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3181 which support adaptive clocking.
3182
3183 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3184 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3185 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3186 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3187 than the speed specified.
3188
3189 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3190 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3191 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3192 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3193
3194 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3195 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3196 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3197 JTAG clocking after setup.
3198 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3199 If the interface device can not
3200 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3201 @end deffn
3202
3203 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3204 @cindex adaptive clocking
3205 @cindex RTCK
3206 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3207 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3208 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3209 @example
3210 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3211 jtag_rclk 3000
3212 @end example
3213 @end defun
3214
3215 @node Reset Configuration
3216 @chapter Reset Configuration
3217 @cindex Reset Configuration
3218
3219 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3220 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3221 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3222 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3223 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3224 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3225 Please see the various board files for examples.
3226
3227 @quotation Note
3228 To maintainers and integrators:
3229 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3230 Normally the board configuration file
3231 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3232 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3233
3234 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3235 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3236 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3237 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3238 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3239 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3240 @end quotation
3241
3242 @section Types of Reset
3243
3244 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3245 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3246 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3247
3248 @itemize @bullet
3249 @item
3250 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3251 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3252 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3253 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3254 @item
3255 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3256 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3257 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3258 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3259 @item
3260 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3261 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3262 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3263 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3264 @item
3265 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3266 several other types of reset.
3267 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3268 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3269 There may be individual module resets.
3270 @end itemize
3271
3272 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3273 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3274 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3275 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3276 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3277 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3278 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3279 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3280 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3281
3282 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3283 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3284
3285 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3286 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3287 common issues are:
3288
3289 @itemize @bullet
3290
3291 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3292 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3293 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3294 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3295 when either of those signals is not connected.
3296 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3297 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3298 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3299 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3300
3301 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3302 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3303 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3304 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3305
3306 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3307 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3308 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3309 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3310 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3311 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3312 hardware debouncing.
3313 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3314 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3315
3316 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3317 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3318 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3319 to use push/pull output drivers.
3320 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3321 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3322 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3323 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3324
3325 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3326 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3327 issues (not limited to errata).
3328 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3329 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3330 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3331 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3332 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3333 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3334 @end itemize
3335
3336 There can also be other issues.
3337 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3338 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3339 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3340 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3341 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3342 Agreement (NDA).
3343
3344 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3345 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3346 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3347
3348 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3349 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3350
3351 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3352
3353 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3354 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3355 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3356 allowing it to be deasserted.
3357 @end deffn
3358
3359 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3360 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3361 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3362 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3363 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3367 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3368 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3369 allowing it to be deasserted.
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3373 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3374 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3378 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3379 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3380 configuration scripts.
3381
3382 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3383 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3384 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3385 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3386 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3387 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3388 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3389 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3390
3391 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3392 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3393 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3394 -- may be specified at a time.
3395 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3396 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3397 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3398 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3399 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3400
3401 @itemize
3402 @item
3403 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3404 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3405 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3406 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3407 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3408
3409 @quotation Tip
3410 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3411 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3412 @end quotation
3413
3414 @item
3415 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3416 signal implementations.
3417 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3418 indicating everything behaves normally.
3419 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3420 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3421 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3422 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3423 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3424 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3425 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3426
3427 @item
3428 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3429 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3430 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3431 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3432 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3433 while SRST is asserted.
3434 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3435 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3436
3437 @item
3438 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3439 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3440 is required to use this option.
3441 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3442 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3443 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3444 be asserted before any target connection.
3445 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3446 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3447 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3448 @end itemize
3449
3450 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3451 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3452 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3453 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3454 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3455
3456 @itemize
3457 @item
3458 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3459 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3460 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3461 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3462
3463 @item
3464 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3465 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3466 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3467 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3468 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3469 @end itemize
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @section Custom Reset Handling
3473 @cindex events
3474
3475 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3476 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3477 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3478 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3479 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3480 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3481
3482 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3483 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3484 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3485 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3486 want to reset everything at once.
3487
3488 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3489 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3490 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3491 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3492 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3493 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3494 needs special attention.
3495
3496 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3497 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3498 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3499 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3500 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3501 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3502 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3503 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3504
3505 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3506 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3507 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3508 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3509 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3510
3511 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3512 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3513 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3514 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3515 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3516 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3517 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3518 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3519 or potentially some other value.
3520
3521 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3522 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3523 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3524 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3525 (or their associated targets)
3526 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3527
3528 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3529 they return.
3530 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3531 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3532 @end deffn
3533
3534 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3535 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3536 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3537 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3538 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3539 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3540 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3541 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3542 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3543 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3544 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3545 @end deffn
3546
3547 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3548 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3549 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3550 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3551 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3552 @end deffn
3553
3554
3555 @node TAP Declaration
3556 @chapter TAP Declaration
3557 @cindex TAP declaration
3558 @cindex TAP configuration
3559
3560 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3561 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3562
3563 @itemize @bullet
3564 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3565 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3566 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3567 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3568 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3569 start running that code.
3570 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3571 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3572 and missing connections.
3573 @end itemize
3574
3575 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3576 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3577 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3578 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3579 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3580
3581 @section Scan Chains
3582 @cindex scan chain
3583
3584 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3585 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3586 They also need to be added to
3587 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3588 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3589 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3590 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3591 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3592 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3593 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3594 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3595
3596 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3597 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3598 command, presented in the next chapter.
3599 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3600 debugging targets.)
3601 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3602
3603 @verbatim
3604 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3605 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3606 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3607 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3608 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3609 @end verbatim
3610
3611 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3612 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3613 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3614 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3615 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3616 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3617 until they are told to do so.
3618
3619 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3620 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3621 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3622 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3623
3624 @example
3625 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3626 @end example
3627
3628 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3629 by a given chip.
3630 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3631 and so forth.
3632 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3633 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3634 both inside a single chip and between them.
3635 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3636
3637 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3638 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3639 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3640 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3641 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3642 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3643 includes commands something like this:
3644
3645 @example
3646 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3647 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3648 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3649 @end example
3650
3651 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3652 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3653 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3654
3655 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3656 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3657 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3658 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3659 @example
3660 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3661 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3662 @}
3663 @end example
3664 @end deffn
3665
3666 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3667 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3668 and their status.
3669 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3670 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3671 but systems with a JTAG router can
3672 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3673 @end deffn
3674
3675 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3676 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3677
3678 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3679 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3680
3681 @section TAP Names
3682 @cindex dotted name
3683
3684 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3685 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3686 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3687 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3688 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3689 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3690 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3691 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3692
3693 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3694 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3695 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3696
3697 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3698
3699 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3700 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3701 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3702 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3703
3704 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3705 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3706 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3707 overridable.
3708
3709 @cindex TAP naming convention
3710 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3711 and should follow this convention:
3712
3713 @itemize @bullet
3714 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3715 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3716 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3717 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3718 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3719 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3720 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3721 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3722 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3723 with a single TAP;
3724 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3725 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3726 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3727 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3731
3732 @itemize @bullet
3733 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3734 @*The length in bits of the
3735 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3736 @end itemize
3737
3738 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3739
3740 @itemize @bullet
3741 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3742 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3743 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3744 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3745 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3746 (the TAP is linked in).
3747 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3748 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3749 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3750 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3751 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3752 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3753 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3754 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3755 values that were found but not included in the list.
3756
3757 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3758 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3759 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3760 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3761 hardware to find these values.
3762 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3763 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3764 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3765 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3766 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3767 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3768 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3769 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3770 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3771 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3772 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3773 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3774 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3775 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3776 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3777 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3778 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3779 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3780 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3781 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3782 @end itemize
3783 @end deffn
3784
3785 @section Other TAP commands
3786
3787 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3788 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3789 At this writing this TAP attribute
3790 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3791 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3792 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3793 See the next section for information about the available events.
3794
3795 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3796 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3797 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3798 @end deffn
3799
3800 @section TAP Events
3801 @cindex events
3802 @cindex TAP events
3803
3804 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3805 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3806 The other applies to debugger targets,
3807 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3808
3809 The TAP events currently defined are:
3810
3811 @itemize @bullet
3812 @item @b{post-reset}
3813 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3814 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3815 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3816 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3817 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3818
3819 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3820 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3821 of any particular target.
3822 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3823 @item @b{setup}
3824 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3825 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3826 @item @b{tap-disable}
3827 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3828 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3829 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3830 @item @b{tap-enable}
3831 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3832 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3833 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3834 @end itemize
3835
3836 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3837 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3838 contents to be accurate), you might:
3839
3840 @example
3841 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3842 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3843 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3844 @}
3845 @end example
3846
3847
3848 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3849 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3850 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3851 @cindex jrc
3852
3853 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3854 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3855 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3856 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3857 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3858
3859 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3860 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3861 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3862 be visible.
3863 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3864 ignores, such as:
3865
3866 @itemize
3867 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3868 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3869 TAPs receive new instructions.
3870 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3871 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3872 @end itemize
3873
3874 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3875 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3876 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3877 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3878
3879 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3880 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3881
3882 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3883 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3884 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3885 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3886 should define TAP event handlers using
3887 code that looks something like this:
3888
3889 @example
3890 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3891 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3892 @}
3893 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3894 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3895 @}
3896 @end example
3897
3898 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3899
3900 @example
3901 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3902 @end example
3903
3904 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3905 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3906 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3907 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3908
3909 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3910 If necessary, disables the tap
3911 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3912 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3913 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3914 and "0" if it is disabled.
3915 @end deffn
3916
3917 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3918 If necessary, enables the tap
3919 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3920 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3921 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3922 and "0" if it is disabled.
3923 @end deffn
3924
3925 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3926 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3927 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3928 and "0" if it is disabled.
3929
3930 @quotation Note
3931 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3932 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3933 @end quotation
3934 @end deffn
3935
3936 @anchor{autoprobing}
3937 @section Autoprobing
3938 @cindex autoprobe
3939 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3940
3941 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3942 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3943 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3944 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3945
3946 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3947 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3948 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3949 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3950 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3951 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3952 right when they come out of reset).
3953
3954 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3955
3956 @example
3957 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3958 reset_config trst_and_srst
3959 jtag_rclk 8
3960 @end example
3961
3962 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3963 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3964
3965 @enumerate
3966 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3967 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3968 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3969 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3970 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3971 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3972 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3973 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3974 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3975 that is discovered.
3976 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3977 register, it will report it.
3978 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3979 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3980 @end enumerate
3981
3982 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3983 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3984 that's a bit more complex:
3985
3986 @example
3987 clock speed 8 kHz
3988 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3989 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3990 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3991 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3992 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3993 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3994 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3995 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3996 @end example
3997
3998 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3999 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4000 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4001 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4002 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4003 and so forth.
4004
4005 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4006 @section DAP declaration (ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4007 @cindex DAP declaration
4008
4009 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4010 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4011 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all
4012 ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4013 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4014
4015 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4016
4017 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name
4018 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4019 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4020 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4021 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4022 @end deffn
4023
4024 @deffn Command {dap names}
4025 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4026 for TCL scripting.
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4030 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4031 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4032 @end deffn
4033
4034 @deffn Command {dap init}
4035 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4036 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4037 initialization, too.
4038 @end deffn
4039
4040 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4041
4042 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4043 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4044 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4045 @end deffn
4046
4047 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4048 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4052 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4053 or set a new value @var{value}.
4054 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4055 @end deffn
4056
4057 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4058 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4059 @end deffn
4060
4061 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4062 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4063 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4064 @end deffn
4065
4066 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4067 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4068 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4069 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4070 @end deffn
4071
4072 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [0 / 1]
4073 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
4074 Defaulting to 0.
4075 @end deffn
4076
4077 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4078 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4079 Disabled by default
4080 @end deffn
4081
4082
4083 @node CPU Configuration
4084 @chapter CPU Configuration
4085 @cindex GDB target
4086
4087 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4088 You can also access these targets without GDB
4089 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4090 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4091 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4092 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4093
4094 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4095 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4096
4097 @section Target List
4098 @cindex target, current
4099 @cindex target, list
4100
4101 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4102 where each member has a name.
4103 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4104 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4105 (plural!) command.
4106 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4107 look like with more than one:
4108 @verbatim
4109 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4110 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4111 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4112 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4113 @end verbatim
4114
4115 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4116 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4117 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4118 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4119 space seen by that current target.
4120 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4121 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4122 are examples; and there are many more.
4123
4124 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4125
4126 @deffn Command {target current}
4127 Returns the name of the current target.
4128 @end deffn
4129
4130 @deffn Command {target names}
4131 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4132 @example
4133 foreach t [target names] @{
4134 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4135 @}
4136 @end example
4137 @end deffn
4138
4139 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4140 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4141
4142 @deffn Command targets [name]
4143 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4144 command names are singular.}
4145
4146 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4147 targets in a user friendly form.
4148
4149 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4150 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4151 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @section Target CPU Types
4155 @cindex target type
4156 @cindex CPU type
4157
4158 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4159 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4160 when calling @command{target create}.
4161 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4162 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4163 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4164 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4165 what core-specific commands may be available
4166 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4167 and more.
4168
4169 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4170 since there's a command to list them.
4171
4172 @anchor{targettypes}
4173 @deffn Command {target types}
4174 Lists all supported target types.
4175 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4176
4177 @itemize @bullet
4178 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4179 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4180 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4181 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4182 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4183 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4184 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4185 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4186 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4187 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4188 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4189 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4190 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4191 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4192 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4193 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4194 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4195 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4196 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4197 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4198 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4199 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4200 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4201 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4202 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4203 @itemize @minus
4204 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4205 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4206 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4207 @end itemize
4208 And two debug interfaces cores:
4209 @itemize @minus
4210 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4211 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4212 @end itemize
4213 @end itemize
4214 @end deffn
4215
4216 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4217 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4218 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4219 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4220 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4221 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4222 reflect design generations;
4223 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4224 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4225
4226 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4227 @section Target Configuration
4228
4229 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4230 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4231 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4232 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4233 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4234
4235 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4236 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4237 optional parts.
4238 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4239 command, created as part of target creation.
4240
4241 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4242 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4243 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4244 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4245 to be much more board-specific.
4246 The key steps you use might look something like this
4247
4248 @example
4249 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4250 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4251 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4252 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4253 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4254 @end example
4255
4256 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4257 on-chip SRAM.
4258 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4259 writes to target memory;
4260 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4261 GDB memory checksumming;
4262 and more.
4263
4264 @quotation Warning
4265 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4266 inaccessible when application code
4267 (such as an operating system)
4268 enables or disables the MMU.
4269 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4270 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4271 easy access to other addresses needed.
4272 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4273 @end quotation
4274
4275 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4276 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4277 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4278 controllers.
4279 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4280 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4281 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4282
4283 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4284 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4285 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4286 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4287 purposes including additional configuration.
4288
4289 @itemize @bullet
4290 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4291 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4292 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4293 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4294
4295 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4296 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4297 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4298 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4299 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4300 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4301 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4302
4303 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4304 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4305 @end itemize
4306 @end deffn
4307
4308 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4309 The options accepted by this command may also be
4310 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4311 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4312 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4313
4314 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4315 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4316 and changing its endianness.
4317
4318 @itemize @bullet
4319
4320 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4321 used to access this target.
4322
4323 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4324 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4325 create and manage DAP instances.
4326
4327 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4328 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4329
4330 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4331 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4332 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4333 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4334 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4335 same event name assigns only one handler.
4336
4337 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4338 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4339
4340 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4341 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4342 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4343 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4344 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4345 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4346 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4347
4348 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4349 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4350 or virtual address is being used.
4351
4352 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4353 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4354
4355 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4356 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4357 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4358 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4359 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4360
4361 @anchor{rtostype}
4362 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4363 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4364 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4365 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}
4366 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4367
4368 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4369 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4370 access the target for debugging.
4371
4372 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4373 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4374 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4375 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4376
4377 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4378 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4379 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4380 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4381 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4382 @end itemize
4383 @end deffn
4384
4385 @section Other $target_name Commands
4386 @cindex object command
4387
4388 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4389 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4390
4391 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4392 Once a button is created a button
4393 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4394 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4395 configure it like this:
4396
4397 @example
4398 # Create
4399 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4400 # Modify
4401 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4402 # Query
4403 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4404 # Report
4405 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4406 @end example
4407
4408 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4409 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4410
4411 @example
4412 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4413 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4414 @end example
4415
4416 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4417
4418 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4419 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4420 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4421 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4422 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4423 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4424 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4425 They are not otherwise documented here.
4426 @end deffn
4427
4428 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4429 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4430 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4431 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4432 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4433 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4434 the target side uses raw memory.
4435
4436 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4437 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4438 The script orientation comes from working with data
4439 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4440 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4441 and neither store nor return those values.
4442
4443 @itemize
4444 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4445 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4446 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4447 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4448 @end itemize
4449 @end deffn
4450
4451 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4452 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4453 @command{$target_name configure}
4454 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4455 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4456 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4457 There are a few special cases:
4458
4459 @itemize @bullet
4460 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4461 event named @var{event_name}.
4462 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4463 two parameters.
4464 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4465 This is a special case because this is set using
4466 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4467 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4468 @end itemize
4469
4470 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4471 all the targets you might use something like this:
4472
4473 @example
4474 foreach name [target names] @{
4475 set y [$name cget -endian]
4476 set z [$name cget -type]
4477 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4478 $x $name $y $z]
4479 @}
4480 @end example
4481 @end deffn
4482
4483 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4484 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4485 Displays the current target state:
4486 @code{debug-running},
4487 @code{halted},
4488 @code{reset},
4489 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4490 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4491 @end deffn
4492
4493 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4494 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4495 currently associated with this target.
4496 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4497 @end deffn
4498
4499 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4500 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4501 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4502 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4503 @end deffn
4504
4505 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4506 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4507 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4508 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4509 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4510 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4511 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4512 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4513 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4514 @end deffn
4515
4516 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4517 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4518 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4519 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4520 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4521 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4522 @end deffn
4523
4524 @anchor{targetevents}
4525 @section Target Events
4526 @cindex target events
4527 @cindex events
4528 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4529 For example:
4530 @itemize @bullet
4531 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4532 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4533 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4534 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4535 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4536 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4537 to set up system clocks or
4538 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4539 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4540 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4541 @end itemize
4542
4543 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4544 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4545 @command{target create ... -event}.
4546
4547 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4548 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4549 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4550
4551 @example
4552 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4553 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4554 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4555 @}
4556 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4557 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4558 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4559 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4560 @}
4561 @end example
4562
4563 The following target events are defined:
4564
4565 @itemize @bullet
4566 @item @b{debug-halted}
4567 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4568 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4569 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4570 @item @b{early-halted}
4571 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4572 @item @b{examine-start}
4573 @* Before target examine is called.
4574 @item @b{examine-end}
4575 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4576 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4577 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4578 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4579 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4580 connect GDB to running target.
4581 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4582 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4583 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4584 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4585 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4586 is in RAM or read only memory.
4587 Default is @code{halt}
4588 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4589 @* When GDB disconnects
4590 @item @b{gdb-end}
4591 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4592 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4593 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4594 @code{reset init})
4595 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4596 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4597 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4598 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4599 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4600 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4601 @item @b{gdb-start}
4602 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4603 @item @b{halted}
4604 @* The target has halted
4605 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4606 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4607 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4608 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4609 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4610 @item @b{reset-assert}
4611 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4612 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4613 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4614 it instead of asserting SRST.
4615 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4616 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4617 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4618 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4619 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4620 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4621 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4622 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4623 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4624 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4625 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4626 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4627 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4628 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4629 released on the scan chain.
4630 @item @b{reset-end}
4631 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4632 @item @b{reset-init}
4633 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4634 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4635
4636 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4637 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4638 multiplexing, and so on.
4639 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4640 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4641 @item @b{reset-start}
4642 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4643 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4644
4645 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4646 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4647 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4648 @item @b{resume-start}
4649 @* Before any target is resumed
4650 @item @b{resume-end}
4651 @* After all targets have resumed
4652 @item @b{resumed}
4653 @* Target has resumed
4654 @item @b{trace-config}
4655 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4656 @end itemize
4657
4658 @node Flash Commands
4659 @chapter Flash Commands
4660
4661 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4662 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4663 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4664 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4665 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4666 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4667 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4668 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4669 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4670
4671 Flash Steps:
4672 @enumerate
4673 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4674 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4675 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4676 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4677 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4678 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4679 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4680 @item GDB Flashing
4681 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4682 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4683 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4684 @end enumerate
4685
4686 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4687 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4688 so that it can't boot.
4689 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4690 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4691
4692 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4693 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4694 @cindex flash configuration
4695
4696 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4697 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4698 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4699 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4700 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4701 see the driver-specific documentation.
4702
4703 @itemize @bullet
4704 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4705 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4706 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4707 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4708 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4709 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4710 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4711 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4712 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4713 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4714 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4715 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4716 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4717 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4718 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4719 commands to the flash controller.
4720 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4721 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4722 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4723 for more information.
4724 @end itemize
4725 @quotation Note
4726 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4727 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4728 @end quotation
4729 @end deffn
4730
4731 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4732 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4733 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4734 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4735 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4736 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4737 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @deffn Command {flash list}
4741 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4742 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4743 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4747 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4748 depends on the flash type.
4749 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4750 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4751 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4752 but most don't bother.
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4756 @cindex flash erasing
4757 @cindex flash reading
4758 @cindex flash writing
4759 @cindex flash programming
4760 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4761
4762 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4763 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4764 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4765 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4766 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4767
4768 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4769 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4770 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4771 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4772 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4773
4774 @quotation Note
4775 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4776 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4777 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4778 back to a flash bank.
4779 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4780 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4781 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4782 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4783 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4784 @end quotation
4785
4786 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4787 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4788 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4789 disabled first.
4790 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4791 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4792 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4793
4794 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4795 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4796 up to and including @var{last}.
4797 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4798 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4799 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4800 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4801 @end deffn
4802
4803 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4804 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4805 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4806 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4807 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4808 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4809 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4810 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4811 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4812 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4813 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4814 before erase starts.
4815 @end deffn
4816
4817 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4818 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4819 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4820 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4821 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4822 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4823 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4824 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4825 before issuing this command.
4826 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4827 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4828 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4829 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4830 @end deffn
4831 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4832
4833 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4834 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4835 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4836 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4837 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4838 @end deffn
4839
4840 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4841 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4842 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4843 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
4844 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
4845 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4846 @end deffn
4847
4848 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4849 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4850 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4851 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4853 @end deffn
4854
4855 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4856 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4857 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4858 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4859 to the base address for each section in the image.
4860 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4861 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4862 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4863 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4864 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4865 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4866 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4867 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4868 each image section.
4869
4870 @quotation Warning
4871 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4872 data you want to preserve.
4873 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4874 sections might be erased with no notice.
4875 @itemize
4876 @item
4877 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4878 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4879 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4880 @item
4881 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4882 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4883 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4884 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4885 @end itemize
4886 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4887 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4888 @end quotation
4889
4890 @end deffn
4891
4892 @section Other Flash commands
4893 @cindex flash protection
4894
4895 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4896 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4897 and display that status.
4898 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4899 @end deffn
4900
4901 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4902 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4903 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4904
4905 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4906 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4907 and possibly stale information.
4908 @end deffn
4909
4910 @anchor{flashprotect}
4911 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4912 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
4913 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
4914 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4915 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
4916 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4917 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4918 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
4919 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
4920 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
4921 @end deffn
4922
4923 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4924 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4925 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4926 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @anchor{program}
4930 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4931 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4932 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4933 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4934 @end deffn
4935
4936 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4937 @section Flash Driver List
4938 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4939 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4940 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4941
4942 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4943 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4944 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4945
4946 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4947
4948 @itemize
4949 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4950 @end itemize
4951
4952 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4953 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4954 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4955 @example
4956 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4957 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
4958 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4959 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
4960 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4961 @end example
4962 @end deffn
4963
4964 @subsection External Flash
4965
4966 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4967 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4968 @cindex CFI
4969 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4970 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4971 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4972 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4973 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4974 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4975 configure a bus and its timings), or
4976 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4977 on the flash chip.
4978 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4979 speed up operation.
4980
4981 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4982
4983 @itemize
4984 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4985 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4986 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4987 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4988 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4989 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4990 @end itemize
4991
4992 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4993 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4994
4995 @example
4996 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4997 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4998 @end example
4999
5000 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5001 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5002 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5003
5004 @example
5005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5006 @end example
5007
5008 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5009 @end deffn
5010
5011 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5012 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5013 @cindex SPI
5014 @cindex jtagspi
5015 @cindex bscan_spi
5016 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5017 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5018 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5019 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5020 accessed through JTAG.
5021
5022 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5023 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5024 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5025 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5026 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5027 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5028
5029 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5030 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5031 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5032 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5033 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5034 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5035 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5036 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5037
5038 @itemize
5039 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5040 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5041 @var{USER1} instruction.
5042 @end itemize
5043
5044 @example
5045 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5046 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5047 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5048 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5049 @end example
5050 @end deffn
5051
5052 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5053 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5054 @cindex xcf
5055 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5056 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5057 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5058 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5059 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5060
5061 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5062 command accepts additional parameters:
5063 @itemize
5064 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5065 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5066 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5067 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5068 in master mode.
5069 @end itemize
5070 @example
5071 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5072 @end example
5073 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5074 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5075 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5076 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5077 dedicated sector.
5078 @end deffn
5079
5080 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5081 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5082 button.
5083 @example
5084 xcf configure 0
5085 @end example
5086 @end deffn
5087
5088 Additional driver notes:
5089 @itemize
5090 @item Only single revision supported.
5091 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5092 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5093 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5094 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5095 @end itemize
5096 @end deffn
5097
5098 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5099 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5100 @cindex SPIFI
5101 @cindex lpcspifi
5102 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5103 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5104 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5105
5106 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5107 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5108 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5109 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5110 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5111
5112 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5113 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5114 are configured by the driver.
5115
5116 @example
5117 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5118 @end example
5119
5120 @end deffn
5121
5122 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5123 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5124 @cindex SMI
5125 @cindex stmsmi
5126 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5127 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5128 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5129 SPI flash devices.
5130 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5131 flash devices can be connected.
5132
5133 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5134 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5135 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5136 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5137 the flash content.
5138
5139 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5140 to identify the memory bank.
5141 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5142 flash size, are detected automatically.
5143
5144 @example
5145 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5146 @end example
5147
5148 @end deffn
5149
5150 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5151 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5152 Microcontroller platform.
5153
5154 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5155 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5156
5157 @example
5158 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5159 @end example
5160
5161 @end deffn
5162
5163 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5164 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5165 @cindex ath79
5166 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5167 chip selects.
5168 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5169 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5170 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5171 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5172 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5173 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5174
5175 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5176 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5177 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5178 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5179 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5180 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5181 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5182 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5183 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5184 with the default CS0.
5185 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5186 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5187 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5188
5189 @example
5190 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5191
5192 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5193 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5194 # banks.
5195 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5196 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5197 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5198 @end example
5199
5200 @end deffn
5201
5202 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5203
5204 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5205 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5206 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5207 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5208 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5209 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5210
5211 @example
5212 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5213 @end example
5214 @end deffn
5215
5216 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5217 @cindex ambiqmicro
5218 @cindex apollo
5219 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5220 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5221 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5222 with the target using SWD.
5223
5224 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5225 the device class of the MCU.
5226 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5227 to set up the flash banks.
5228 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5229 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5230
5231 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5232 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5233 and the second bank starts after the first.
5234
5235 @example
5236 # Flash bank 0
5237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5238 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5239 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5240 $_TARGETNAME
5241 @end example
5242
5243 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5244 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5245 are available to the user.
5246
5247 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5248
5249 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5250 Erase entire bank.
5251 @end deffn
5252 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5253 Erase device pages.
5254 @end deffn
5255 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5256 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5257 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5258 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5259 the flash.
5260 @end deffn
5261 @end deffn
5262
5263 @anchor{at91samd}
5264 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5265 @cindex at91samd
5266 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5267 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5268 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5269
5270 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5271 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5272 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5273 processor to be halted.
5274 @end deffn
5275
5276 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5277 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5278 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5279 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5280 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5281 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5282
5283 @example
5284 at91samd set-security enable
5285 @end example
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5289 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5290 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5291 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5292 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5293 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5294 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5295 in order to disable this feature.
5296
5297 @example
5298 at91samd eeprom
5299 at91samd eeprom 1024
5300 @end example
5301 @end deffn
5302
5303 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5304 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5305 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5306 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5307 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5308 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5309
5310 @example
5311 at91samd bootloader
5312 at91samd bootloader 16384
5313 @end example
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5317 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5318 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5319 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5320 @end deffn
5321
5322 @end deffn
5323
5324 @anchor{at91sam3}
5325 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5326 @cindex at91sam3
5327 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5328 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5329 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5330 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5331 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5332 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5333 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5334 chips are confirmed.}
5335
5336 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5337 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5338 the following fixed locations:
5339
5340 @example
5341 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5342 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5343 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5345 @end example
5346
5347 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5348 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5349 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5350
5351 @itemize
5352 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5353 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5354 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5355 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5356 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5357 @end itemize
5358
5359 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5360
5361 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5362 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5363 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5364 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5365 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5366 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5367 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5368
5369 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5370 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5374 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5375 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5376 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5377 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5378 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5379 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5380 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5381 @end deffn
5382
5383 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5384 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5385 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5386 @end deffn
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5390 @cindex at91sam4
5391 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5392 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5393 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5394 @end deffn
5395
5396 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5397 @cindex at91sam4l
5398 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5399 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5400 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5401
5402 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5403 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5404 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5405 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5406 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5407 @end deffn
5408 @end deffn
5409
5410 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5411 @cindex atsamv
5412 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5413 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5414 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5415 @end deffn
5416
5417 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5418 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5419 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5420 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5421 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5422
5423 @example
5424 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5425 @end example
5426
5427 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5428 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5429
5430 @itemize
5431 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5432 @item @var{banks}
5433 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5434 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5435 @item @var{pages_size}
5436 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5437 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5438 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5439 @end itemize
5440
5441 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5442 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5443 will be autoconfigured.
5444 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5445
5446 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5447 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5448 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5449 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5450 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5451
5452 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5453 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5454 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5455 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5456 are not truly general purpose).
5457 @quotation Note
5458 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5459 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5460 @end quotation
5461 @end deffn
5462 @end deffn
5463
5464 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5465 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5466 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5467 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5468 @end deffn
5469
5470 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5471 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5472 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5473 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5474
5475 @example
5476 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5477 @end example
5478
5479 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5480 each single sector one by one.
5481
5482 @example
5483 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5484 @end example
5485
5486 @example
5487 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5488 @end example
5489
5490 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5491
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5495 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5496 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5497 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5498 autoconfigures itself.
5499 @example
5500 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5501 @end example
5502 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5503 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5504 this via the following command:
5505 @example
5506 efm32 debuglock num
5507 @end example
5508 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5509 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5510 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5511 supported.}
5512 @end deffn
5513
5514 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5515 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5516 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5517 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5518 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5519 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5520 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5521
5522 @example
5523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5524 @end example
5525 @end deffn
5526
5527 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5528 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5529 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5530 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5531 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5532 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5533 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5534 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5535 characters) ignored.
5536
5537 @example
5538 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5539 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5540 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5541 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5542 @end example
5543 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5544 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5548 @cindex kinetis
5549 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5550 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5551 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5552 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5553 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5554 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5555
5556 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5557 @itemize
5558 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5559 @end itemize
5560
5561 @example
5562 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5563 @end example
5564
5565 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5566 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5567 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5568 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5572 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5573 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5574 set by 'flash protect' command.
5575 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5576 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5577 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5578 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5579 with the rest of a flash image.
5580 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5581 @end deffn
5582
5583 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5584 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5585 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5586 @end deffn
5587
5588 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5589 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5590 @end deffn
5591
5592 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5593 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5594 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5598 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5599 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5600 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5601 command completes.
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5605 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5606 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5607 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5608 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5609
5610 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5611 Program Partition command.
5612
5613 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5614 Reset the device after partition setting.
5615
5616 Show partition size:
5617 @example
5618 kinetis nvm_partition info
5619 @end example
5620
5621 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5622 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5623 @example
5624 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5625 @end example
5626
5627 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5628 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5629 @example
5630 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5631 @end example
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5635 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5636 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5640 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5641 Command disables watchdog timer.
5642 @end deffn
5643 @end deffn
5644
5645 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5646 @cindex kinetis_ke
5647 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5648 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5649 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5650 autoconfigures itself.
5651 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5652
5653 @example
5654 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5655 @end example
5656
5657 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5658 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5659 @end deffn
5660
5661 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5662 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5663 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5664 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5665 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5669 Command disables watchdog timer.
5670 @end deffn
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5674 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5675 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5676 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5677 microcontroller families from NXP.
5678
5679 @quotation Note
5680 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5681 driver:
5682 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5683 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5684 @end quotation
5685
5686 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5687 which must appear in the following order:
5688
5689 @itemize
5690 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5691 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5692 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5693 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5694 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5695 LPC43x[2357])
5696 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5697 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5698 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5699 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5700 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5701 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5702 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5703 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5704 at which the core is running
5705 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5706 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5707 @quotation Note
5708 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5709 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5710 However, if you do provide it,
5711 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5712 @end quotation
5713 @end itemize
5714
5715 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5716
5717 @example
5718 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5719 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5720 @end example
5721
5722 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5723 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5724 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5725 @end deffn
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5729 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5730 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5731 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5732 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5733 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5734
5735 @example
5736 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5737 @end example
5738 @end deffn
5739
5740 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5741 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5742 from NXP.
5743
5744 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5745 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5746 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5747 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5748 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5749 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5750 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5751 you start the PLL.
5752
5753 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5754
5755 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5756 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5757 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5758
5759 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5760 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5761 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5762 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5763 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5764 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5765 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5766
5767 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5768 @example
5769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5770 @end example
5771
5772 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5773 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5774 @code{flash banks} command.
5775
5776 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5777 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5778 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5779 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5780 a known signature.
5781 Example:
5782 @example
5783 lpc2900 signature 0
5784 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5785 @end example
5786 @end deffn
5787
5788 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5789 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5790 saves it to a file in binary format.
5791 Example:
5792 @example
5793 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5794 @end example
5795 @end deffn
5796
5797 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5798 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5799 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5800 command:
5801
5802 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5803 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5804 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5805 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5806
5807 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5808 Example:
5809 @example
5810 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5811 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5812 @end example
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5816 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5817 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5818 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5819 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5820 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5821 912 bytes.
5822 @quotation Attention
5823 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5824 @end quotation
5825 Example:
5826 @example
5827 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5828 @end example
5829 @end deffn
5830
5831 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5832 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5833 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5834 after the next power cycle.
5835 @quotation Attention
5836 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5837 @end quotation
5838 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5839 Example:
5840 @example
5841 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5842 flash info 0
5843 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5844 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5845 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5846 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5847 @end example
5848 @end deffn
5849
5850 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5851 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5852 effective after the next power cycle.
5853 @quotation Attention
5854 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5855 @end quotation
5856 Examples:
5857 @example
5858 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5859 @end example
5860 @end deffn
5861 @end deffn
5862
5863 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5864 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5865 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5866 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5867
5868 @example
5869 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5870 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5871 @end example
5872
5873 @itemize @bullet
5874 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5875 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5876 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5877 @end itemize
5878
5879 Example usage:
5880 @example
5881 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5882 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5883 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5884 @} else @{
5885 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5886 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5887 @}
5888 @end example
5889 @end deffn
5890
5891 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5892 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5893 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5894 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5895 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5896 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5897 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5898 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5899 also have division into regions: main and info.
5900 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5901 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5902
5903 @example
5904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5905 @end example
5906
5907 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5908
5909 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5910 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5911 @end deffn
5912
5913 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5914 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5918 Erase all userflash including info region.
5919 @end deffn
5920
5921 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5922 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5923 @end deffn
5924
5925 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5926 Check sectors protect.
5927 @end deffn
5928
5929 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5930 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5931 @end deffn
5932
5933 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5934 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5938 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5942 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5943 @end deffn
5944
5945 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5946 Show information about flash driver.
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
5952 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5953 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5954 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
5955 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
5956
5957 @example
5958 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5959 @end example
5960
5961 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
5962
5963 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
5964 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5965 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5966 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5967 code.
5968 @end deffn
5969
5970 @end deffn
5971
5972 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5973 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5974 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5975
5976 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5977 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5978 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5979 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5980
5981 @example
5982 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5983 @end example
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5987 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5988 and integrate flash memory.
5989
5990 @example
5991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5992 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5993 @end example
5994
5995 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5996 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5997 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5998 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5999 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6000 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6001 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6002 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6003 @end deffn
6004 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6005 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6006 This will remove any Code Protection.
6007 @end deffn
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6011 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6012 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6013 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6014 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6015
6016 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6017 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6018
6019 @example
6020 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6021 @end example
6022
6023 psoc4-specific commands
6024 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6025 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6026
6027 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6028 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6029
6030 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6031 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6032 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6033
6034 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6038 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6039
6040 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6041 @end deffn
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6045 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6046 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6047 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6048
6049 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6050 @itemize @bullet
6051 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6052 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6053 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6054 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6055 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6056 row size: 512 bytes.
6057 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6058 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6059 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6060 operation will erase row automatically.
6061 @end itemize
6062
6063 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6064 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6065
6066 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6067
6068 @example
6069 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6070 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6071 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6072 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6073 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6074 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6075
6076 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6077 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6078 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6079 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6080 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6081 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6082 @end example
6083
6084 psoc6-specific commands
6085 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6086 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6087 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6088 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6089 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6090 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6091 @end deffn
6092
6093 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6094 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6095 by @command{flash banks}.
6096 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6097 @end deffn
6098 @end deffn
6099
6100 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6101 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6102 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6103 and SWD interface.
6104 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6105 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6106
6107 @example
6108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6109 @end example
6110
6111 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6112
6113 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6114 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6115 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6116 @end deffn
6117
6118 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6119 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6120 @end deffn
6121 @end deffn
6122
6123 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6124 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6125 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6126 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6127 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6128
6129 @example
6130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6131 @end example
6132
6133 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6134 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6135 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6136 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6137 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6138 disabled.
6139
6140 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6141 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6142 @quotation Warning
6143 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6144 applied to all of them.
6145 @end quotation
6146 @end deffn
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6150 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6151 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6152 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6153 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6154
6155 @example
6156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6157 @end example
6158
6159 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6160 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6161 the flash driver.
6162
6163 @example
6164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6165 @end example
6166
6167 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6168 as per the following example.
6169 @example
6170 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6171 @end example
6172
6173 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6174
6175 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6176 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6177 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6181 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6182 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6183 @end deffn
6184
6185 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6186 Mass erases the entire stm32f1x device.
6187 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6191 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
6192 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
6193 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6194 @end deffn
6195
6196 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6197 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6198 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6199 @end deffn
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6203 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6204 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6205 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6206 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6207
6208 @example
6209 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6210 @end example
6211
6212 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6213 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6214 the flash driver.
6215
6216 @example
6217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6218 @end example
6219
6220 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6221
6222 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6223 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6224 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6225 @end deffn
6226
6227 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6228 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6229 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6233 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6238 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6243 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6244 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6245 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6246 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6247 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6251 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6253 @end deffn
6254 @end deffn
6255
6256 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6257 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6258 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6259 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6260 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6261
6262 @example
6263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6264 @end example
6265
6266 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6267 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6268 the flash driver.
6269
6270 @example
6271 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6272 @end example
6273
6274 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6275
6276 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6277 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6278 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6282 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6284 @end deffn
6285
6286 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6287 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6289 @end deffn
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6293 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6294 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6295 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6296 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6297
6298 @example
6299 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6300 @end example
6301
6302 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6303 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6304 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6305 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6306 second bank.
6307
6308 @example
6309 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6310 @end example
6311
6312 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6313
6314 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6315 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6316 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6317 @end deffn
6318
6319 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6320 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6321 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6325 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6326 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6327 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6328 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6329 @end deffn
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6333 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6334 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6335 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6336 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6337
6338 @example
6339 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6340 @end example
6341
6342 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6343 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6344 the flash driver.
6345
6346 @example
6347 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6348 @end example
6349
6350 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6351
6352 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6353 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6354 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6355 @end deffn
6356
6357 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6358 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6359 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6363 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6364 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6365 @end deffn
6366 @end deffn
6367
6368 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6369 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6370 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6371 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6372 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6373
6374 @example
6375 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6376 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6377 @end example
6378
6379 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6380 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6381 for the specified flash bank.
6382 @end deffn
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6386 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6387 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6388 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6389 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6390
6391 @example
6392 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6393 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6394 @end example
6395
6396 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6397 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6398 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6399
6400 @itemize @bullet
6401 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6402 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6403 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6404 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6405 @end itemize
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6411 @cindex str9xpec
6412
6413 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6414 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6415 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6416 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6417
6418 Here is some background info to help
6419 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6420 the str9:
6421 @enumerate
6422 @item
6423 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6424 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6425 @item
6426 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6427 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6428 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6429 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6430 @end enumerate
6431
6432 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6433 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6434 configured for flash bank 0.
6435 @example
6436 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6437 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6438 jtag_reset 0 1
6439 # turn off target polling
6440 poll off
6441 # disable str9 core
6442 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6443 # read option bytes
6444 str9xpec options_read 0
6445 # re-enable str9 core
6446 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6447 poll on
6448 reset halt
6449 @end example
6450 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6451 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6452 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6453 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6454
6455 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6456
6457 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6458 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6462 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6463 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6467 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6468 erase the device.
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6472 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6476 Configure str9 boot bank.
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6480 Configure str9 lvd source.
6481 @end deffn
6482
6483 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6484 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6488 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6489 @end deffn
6490
6491 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6492 Read str9 option bytes.
6493 @end deffn
6494
6495 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6496 Write str9 option bytes.
6497 @end deffn
6498
6499 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6500 unlock str9 device.
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6506 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6507 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6508 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6509
6510 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6511
6512 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6513 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6517 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6521 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6522 the flash clock.
6523 @end deffn
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6527 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6528 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6532 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6533 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6534
6535 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6536
6537 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6538 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6542 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @section NAND Flash Commands
6548 @cindex NAND
6549
6550 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6551 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6552 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6553
6554 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6555 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6556 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6557 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6558 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6559 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6560
6561 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6562 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6563 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6564 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6565 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6566 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6567 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6568 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6569 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6570 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6571
6572 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6573 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6574 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6575 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6576 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6577 every 512 bytes of data.
6578
6579 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6580 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6581 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6582 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6583 ECC mode is used.
6584
6585 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6586 @enumerate
6587 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6588 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6589 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6590 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6591 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6592 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6593 to access that device.
6594 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6595 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6596 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6597 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6598 de-brick a board.
6599 @end enumerate
6600
6601 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6602 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6603 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6604 are only 32 bits wide.
6605 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6606 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6607 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6608 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6609
6610 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6611 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6612 @cindex NAND configuration
6613
6614 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6615 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6616 OpenOCD has initialized.
6617
6618 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6619 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6620 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6621 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6622 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6623 they were a single (larger) device.
6624 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6625 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6626
6627 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6628 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6629 configuration files, not interactively.
6630
6631 @itemize @bullet
6632 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6633 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6634 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6635 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6636 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6637 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6638 commands to the NAND controller.
6639 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6640 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6641 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6642 for more information.
6643 @end itemize
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn Command {nand list}
6647 Prints a summary of each device declared
6648 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6649 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6650 @example
6651 > nand list
6652 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6653 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6654 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6655 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6656 >
6657 @end example
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6661 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6662 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6663 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6664 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6665 it with most other NAND commands.
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6669
6670 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6671 @cindex NAND reading
6672 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6673 starting at the specified offset.
6674 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6675
6676 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6677 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6678
6679 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6680 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6681 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6682
6683 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6684 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6685 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6686 method which handled that error correction.
6687
6688 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6689 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6690 @itemize @bullet
6691 @item no oob_* parameter
6692 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6693 @item @code{oob_raw}
6694 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6695 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6696 spare areas associated with each data page.
6697 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6698 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6699 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6700 @item @code{oob_only}
6701 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6702 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6703 spare areas associated with each data page.
6704 @end itemize
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6708 @cindex NAND erasing
6709 @cindex NAND programming
6710 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6711 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6712 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6713 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6714 If those parameters are not specified,
6715 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6716 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6717
6718 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6719 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6720 block marker.
6721 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6722 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6726 @cindex NAND writing
6727 @cindex NAND programming
6728 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6729 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6730 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6731 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6732
6733 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6734 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6735
6736 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6737 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6738 past the end of the device.
6739 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6740 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6741 if that's being written.)
6742
6743 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6744 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6745 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6746
6747 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6748 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6749 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6750 @itemize @bullet
6751 @item no oob_* parameter
6752 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6753 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6754 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6755 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6756 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6757 @item @code{oob_only}
6758 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6759 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6760 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6761 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6762 @item @code{oob_raw}
6763 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6764 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6765 un-altered OOB.
6766 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6767 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6768 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6769 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6770 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6771 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6772 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6773 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6774 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6775 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6776 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6777 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6778 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6779 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6780 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6781 @end itemize
6782 @end deffn
6783
6784 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6785 @cindex NAND verification
6786 @cindex NAND programming
6787 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6788 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6789 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6790
6791 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6792 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6793
6794 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6795 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6796 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6797 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6798 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6799
6800 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6801 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6802 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6803
6804 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6805 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6806 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6807 be removed in a future release.
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @subsection Other NAND commands
6811 @cindex NAND other commands
6812
6813 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6814 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6815 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6816 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6817 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6818 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6819 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6820 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6821
6822 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6823 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6824 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6828 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6829 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6830 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6831 status for each block.
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6835 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6836 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6837
6838 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6839 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6840 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6841 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6842 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6843
6844 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6845 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6846 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6847 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6848 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6849 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6850 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6854 @subsection NAND Driver List
6855 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6856 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6857 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6858
6859 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6860 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6861 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6862 address of the ECC controller.
6863 @example
6864 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6865 @end example
6866 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6867 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6868 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6869 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6870 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6871 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6872 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6873 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6874 @end deffn
6875 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6876 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6877 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6881 properly configured for input or output.
6882 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6883 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6884 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6885 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6886 @end deffn
6887 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6888 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6889 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6890 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6891 @end deffn
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6895 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6896 chips from Texas Instruments.
6897 It takes three extra parameters:
6898 address of the NAND chip;
6899 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6900 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6901 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6902 @example
6903 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6904 @end example
6905 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6906 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6907 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6908 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6909 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6913 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6914 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6915 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6916 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6917 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6918 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6922 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6923 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6924 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6925 @end deffn
6926 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6927
6928 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6929 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6930 should work for this chip aswell.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6934 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6935 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6936 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6937 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6938 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6939 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6940 @example
6941 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6942 @end example
6943 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6944 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6945 without parameter query status.
6946 @end deffn
6947 @end deffn
6948
6949 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6950 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6951 parameter: the address of the controller.
6952 @example
6953 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6954 @end example
6955 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6956 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6957 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6958 change any behavior.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6962 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6963 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6964 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6965 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6966 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6967 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6968 specialized commands.
6969 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6970 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6971 change any behavior.
6972 @end deffn
6973
6974 @section mFlash
6975
6976 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6977 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6978
6979 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6980 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6981 address @var{base}.
6982 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6983 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6984
6985 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6986
6987 @example
6988 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6989 @end example
6990
6991 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6992
6993 @example
6994 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6995 @end example
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998 @subsection mFlash commands
6999 @cindex mFlash commands
7000
7001 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7002 Configure mflash PLL.
7003 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7004 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7005 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7006 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7010 Configure bootable option.
7011 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7012 (4kB) for boot.
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7016 Configure storage information.
7017 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7018 written.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7022 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7023 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7027 Probe mflash.
7028 @end deffn
7029
7030 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7031 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7032 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7033 @end deffn
7034
7035 @node Flash Programming
7036 @chapter Flash Programming
7037
7038 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7039 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7040 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7041
7042 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7043 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7044
7045 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
7046 @enumerate
7047 @item 'init' is executed.
7048 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7049 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7050 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7051 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7052 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7053 @end enumerate
7054
7055 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7056
7057 @example
7058 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7059 # are optional parameters
7060 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7061 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7062
7063 # binary files need the flash address passing
7064 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7065 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7066 @end example
7067
7068 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7069 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7070 @cindex PLD
7071 @cindex FPGA
7072
7073 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7074 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7075 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7076 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7077 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7078 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7079 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7080
7081 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7082
7083 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7084 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7085 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7086
7087 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7088 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7089
7090 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7091 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7092 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7093 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7094 behavior.
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7098 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7102 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7103 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7107
7108 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7109 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7110 that particular type of PLD.
7111
7112 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7113 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7114 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7115
7116 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7117 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7118 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7119
7120 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7121 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7122 for FPGA @var{num}.
7123 @end deffn
7124 @end deffn
7125
7126 @node General Commands
7127 @chapter General Commands
7128 @cindex commands
7129
7130 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7131 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7132 commands are documented elsewhere.
7133
7134 Intent:
7135 @itemize @bullet
7136 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7137 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7138 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
7139 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7140
7141 @item @b{From the human}
7142 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7143 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7144
7145 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7146 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7147 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7148
7149 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7150 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7151 port is 5555.
7152 @end itemize
7153
7154
7155 @section Server Commands
7156
7157 @deffn {Command} exit
7158 Exits the current telnet session.
7159 @end deffn
7160
7161 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7162 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7163 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7164 Not every command provides helptext.
7165
7166 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7167 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7168 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7169 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7173 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7174 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7175 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7176 Useful in connection with script files
7177 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7181 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7182 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7183 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @anchor{debuglevel}
7187 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7188 @cindex message level
7189 Display debug level.
7190 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7191 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7192 Level 0 is error messages only;
7193 level 1 adds warnings;
7194 level 2 adds informational messages;
7195 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7196 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7197 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7198 the command line along with the location of that log
7199 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7200 @xref{Running}.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7204 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7205 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7206 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7207 @example
7208 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7209 @end example
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7213 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7214 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7218 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7222 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7223 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7224 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7225 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7229 @section Target State handling
7230 @cindex reset
7231 @cindex halt
7232 @cindex target initialization
7233
7234 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7235 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7236 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7237 a current target which is used to perform the
7238 various operations. The current target may be changed
7239 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7240 target which should become current.
7241
7242 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7243 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7244 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7245 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7246 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7247
7248 @emph{With no arguments}:
7249 list all available registers for the current target,
7250 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7251 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7252 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7253 are flagged as such.
7254
7255 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7256 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7257 bypassing any internal cache.
7258
7259 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7260 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7261 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7262 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7263 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7264 relevant module will flush such values.
7265
7266 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7267 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7268
7269 @example
7270 > reg
7271 ===== ARM registers
7272 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7273 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7274 (2) r2 (/32)
7275 ...
7276 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7277 >
7278 @end example
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7282 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7283 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7284 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7285 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7286 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7287 (and enter debug mode).
7288 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7289
7290 @quotation Warning
7291 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7292 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7293 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7294 power mode by gating the core clock;
7295 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7296
7297 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7298 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7299 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7300 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7301 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7302 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7303
7304 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7305 work with a JTAG debugger.
7306 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
7307 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7308 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7309 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7310 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7311 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7312 @end quotation
7313
7314 @end deffn
7315
7316 @deffn Command resume [address]
7317 Resume the target at its current code position,
7318 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7319 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7320 @end deffn
7321
7322 @deffn Command step [address]
7323 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7324 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @anchor{resetcommand}
7328 @deffn Command reset
7329 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7330 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7331 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7332 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7333 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7334 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7335
7336 The optional parameter specifies what should
7337 happen after the reset.
7338 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7339 The other options will not work on all systems.
7340 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7341
7342 @itemize @minus
7343 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7344 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7345 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7346 @end itemize
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7350 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7351 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7352 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7353 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7354 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7355 state.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @section I/O Utilities
7359
7360 These commands are available when
7361 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7362 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7363 notably the ZY1000.
7364 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7365
7366 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7367
7368 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7369 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7370 the text file @file{filename}.
7371 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7372 The last string is followed by a newline.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn Command cat filename
7376 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7380 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7381 into @file{dest_filename}.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn Command ip
7385 @emph{No description provided.}
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn Command ls
7389 @emph{No description provided.}
7390 @end deffn
7391
7392 @deffn Command mac
7393 @emph{No description provided.}
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn Command meminfo
7397 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7398 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7399 @end deffn
7400
7401 @deffn Command peek
7402 @emph{No description provided.}
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn Command poke
7406 @emph{No description provided.}
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn Command rm filename
7410 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7411 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command trunc filename
7415 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7419 @section Memory access commands
7420 @cindex memory access
7421
7422 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7423 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7424 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7425 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7426
7427 @enumerate
7428 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7429 to change the current target.
7430 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7431 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7432 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7433 @end enumerate
7434
7435 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7436 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7437 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7438 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7439 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7440 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7441 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7442 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7443 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7444 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7445 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7446 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7447 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7448 @end deffn
7449
7450 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7451 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7452 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7453 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7454 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7455 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7456 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7457 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7458 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7459 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7460 @end deffn
7461
7462 @anchor{imageaccess}
7463 @section Image loading commands
7464 @cindex image loading
7465 @cindex image dumping
7466
7467 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7468 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7469 binary file named @var{filename}.
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7473 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7474 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7475 @end deffn
7476
7477 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7478 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7479 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7480 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7481 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7482 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7483 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7484 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7485 separately.
7486 @end deffn
7487
7488 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7489 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7490 The file format may optionally be specified
7491 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7492 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7493 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7494 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7495 @example
7496 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7497 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7498 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7499 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7500 $address $length
7501 @}
7502 @end example
7503 @end deffn
7504
7505 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7506 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7507 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7508 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7509 The file format may optionally be specified
7510 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7514 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7515 The file format may optionally be specified
7516 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7517 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7518 @end deffn
7519
7520 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7521 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7522 The file format may optionally be specified
7523 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7524 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7525 @end deffn
7526
7527
7528 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7529 @cindex breakpoint
7530 @cindex watchpoint
7531
7532 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7533 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7534 watchpoints.
7535 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7536
7537 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7538 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7539 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7540 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7541 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7542 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7543
7544 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7545 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7549 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7553 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7557 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7558 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7559 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7560 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7561 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7562 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7563 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7564 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7565 @end deffn
7566
7567 @section Misc Commands
7568
7569 @cindex profiling
7570 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7571 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7572 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7573 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7574 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7575 limit the address range.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command {version}
7579 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7580 @end deffn
7581
7582 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7583 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7584 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7585 @end deffn
7586
7587 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7588 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7589 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7590 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7591
7592 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7593 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7594 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7595 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7596
7597 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7598 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7599 @cindex tracing
7600 @cindex ETM
7601 @cindex ETB
7602
7603 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7604 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7605 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7606
7607 @itemize
7608 @item
7609 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7610 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7611 supports such an interface.
7612 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7613 and trace port support.)
7614 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7615 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7616 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7617 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7618 in the board-specific configuration file.
7619 @item
7620 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7621 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7622 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7623 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7624 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7625 @end itemize
7626
7627 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7628
7629 @quotation Issues
7630 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7631 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7632
7633 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7634 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7635 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7636 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7637 dummy trace port driver}.
7638
7639 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7640 as well as tracing only during specific states
7641 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7642
7643 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7644 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7645 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7646 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7647 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7648
7649 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7650 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7651 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7652 this original style of JTAG access.
7653 @end quotation
7654
7655 @subsection ETM Configuration
7656 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7657
7658 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7659 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7660 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7661
7662 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7663 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7664 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7665 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7666 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7667 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7668 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7669 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7670 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7671
7672 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7673 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7674 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7675
7676 @quotation Warning
7677 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7678 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7679 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7680 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7681 @end quotation
7682
7683 @quotation Note
7684 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7685 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7686 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7687 what CPU activities are traced.
7688 @end quotation
7689 @end deffn
7690
7691 @deffn Command {etm info}
7692 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7693 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7694 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7695 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn Command {etm status}
7699 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7700 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7701 Did trace data overflow?
7702 Was it triggered?
7703 @end deffn
7704
7705 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7706 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7707 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7708 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7709 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7710
7711 @itemize
7712 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7713 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7714 The value is one of
7715 @option{none} (save nothing),
7716 @option{data} (save data),
7717 @option{address} (save addresses),
7718 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7719 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7720 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7721 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7722 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7723 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7724 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7725 trace stream without an image of the code.
7726 @end itemize
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7730 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7731 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7732 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7733 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7734
7735 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7736 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7737 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7741
7742 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7743 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7744 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7745
7746 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7747 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7748 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7749 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7750 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7751 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7752 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7753
7754 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7755
7756 @itemize
7757 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7758 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7759 for instruction access within that function's body.
7760 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7761 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7762 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7763 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7764 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7765 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7766 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7767 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7768 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7769 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7770 @item @emph{... more}
7771 @end itemize
7772
7773 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7774 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7775
7776 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7777 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7778 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7782 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7786 Opens an image file.
7787 @end deffn
7788
7789 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7790 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @deffn Command {etm start}
7794 Starts trace data collection.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7798 Stops trace data collection.
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7802 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7803
7804 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7805
7806 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7807 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7808 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7809 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7810 any trace data collection.}
7811 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7812 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7813 @end deffn
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7817 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7818 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7819 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7820 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7821 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7822 @end deffn
7823 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7824 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7825 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7826 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7827 trace trigger becomes active.
7828
7829 @itemize
7830 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7831 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7832 afterwards.
7833 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7834 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7835 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7836 what caused that event to happen.
7837 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7838 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7839 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7840 how the event caused trouble.
7841 @end itemize
7842 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @end deffn
7846
7847 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7848 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7849 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7850 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7851 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7852
7853 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7854 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7855
7856 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7857 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7858 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7862 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7863 @end deffn
7864
7865 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7866 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7867 @end deffn
7868 @end deffn
7869
7870 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
7871 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
7872 @cindex CTI
7873
7874 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
7875 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
7876 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
7877 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
7878 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
7879 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
7880
7881 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
7882 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
7883 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
7884 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
7885 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
7886 including additional configuration.
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
7890 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
7894 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
7898 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
7902 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7903 @end deffn
7904
7905 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
7906 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
7907 of the CTI.
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @deffn Command {cti names}
7911 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
7912 useful in TCL scripting.
7913 @end deffn
7914
7915 @section Generic ARM
7916 @cindex ARM
7917
7918 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7919 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7920 commands that may be available.
7921
7922 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7923 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7924 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7925 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7926 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7927 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7931 @cindex disassemble
7932 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7933 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7934 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7935 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7936 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7937 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7938 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7939
7940 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7941 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7942 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7943 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7944 with a handful of exceptions.
7945 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7946 @end deffn
7947
7948 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7949 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7950 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7951 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7952 and using the MCR instruction.
7953 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7954 an ARM register.)
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7958 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7959 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7960 and the MRC instruction.
7961 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7962 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7963 an ARM register.)
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7967 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7968 core mode if necessary.
7969 @end deffn
7970
7971 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7972 @cindex ARM semihosting
7973 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7974
7975 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7976 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7977 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7978 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7979 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7980 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7984 @cindex ARM semihosting
7985 Set the command line to be passed to the debuggee.
7986
7987 @example
7988 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
7989 @end example
7990
7991 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
7992 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
7993 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
7994 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7998 @cindex ARM semihosting
7999 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8000 status.
8001
8002 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8003 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8004 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8005 debugger.
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8009 @cindex ARMv4
8010 @cindex ARMv5
8011
8012 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8013 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8014 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8015 variant.
8016
8017 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8018 @cindex ARM7
8019 @cindex ARM9
8020
8021 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8022 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8023 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8024 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8025
8026 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8027 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8028 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8029 instead of breakpoints.
8030 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8031
8032 This should be
8033 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8034 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8035 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8039 @cindex DCC
8040 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8041 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8042 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8043
8044 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8045 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8046 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8047 @end deffn
8048
8049 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8050 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8051 that don't check completion of the operation.
8052 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8053
8054 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8055 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8056 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8057 @end deffn
8058
8059 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8060 @cindex ARM720T
8061
8062 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8063 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8064 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8065 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8066
8067 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8068 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8069 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8070
8071 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8072 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8073 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8077 @cindex ARM9
8078
8079 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8080 integer processors.
8081 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8082
8083 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8084 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8085 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8086 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8087
8088 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8089 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8090 @cindex vector_catch
8091 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8092 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8093 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8094 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8095 to those hardware vectors.
8096
8097 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8098 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8099 vector catch hardware to intercept
8100 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8101 @option{none} of them,
8102 or a list with one or more of the following:
8103 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8104 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8105 @end deffn
8106
8107 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8108 @cindex ARM920T
8109
8110 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8111 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8112 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8113 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8114 and ARM9 commands.
8115
8116 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8117 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8118 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8122 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8123 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8124 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8125 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8126 (Not all registers can be written.)
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8130 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8131 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8132
8133 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8134 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8135 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8136 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8137 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8138 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8142 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8143 @end deffn
8144
8145 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8146 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8150 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8151
8152 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8153 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8154 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8155 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8156 and ARM9 commands.
8157
8158 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8159 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8160
8161 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8162 Print information about the caches found.
8163 @end deffn
8164
8165 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8166 @cindex ARM966E
8167
8168 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8169 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8170 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8171 and ARM9 commands.
8172
8173 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8174 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8175 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8176 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8177 ARM966E-S TRM.
8178 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8179 as required for BIST support.
8180 @end deffn
8181
8182 @subsection XScale specific commands
8183 @cindex XScale
8184
8185 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8186
8187 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8188 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8189 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8190 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8191 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8192 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8193 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8194
8195 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8196 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
8197 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8198 the mini-IC.
8199
8200 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8201 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8202 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8203 code layout in memory:
8204 @example
8205 _vectors:
8206 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8207 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8208 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8209 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8210 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8211 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8212 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8213 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8214 .org 0x100
8215 .long real_reset_vector
8216 .long real_ui_handler
8217 .long real_swi_handler
8218 .long real_pf_abort
8219 .long real_data_abort
8220 .long 0 /* unused */
8221 .long real_irq_handler
8222 .long real_fiq_handler
8223 @end example
8224
8225 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8226 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8227 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8228 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8229 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8230 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8231 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8232 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8233 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8234 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8235 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8236 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8237 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8238 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8239 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8240 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8241 software.
8242
8243 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8244 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8245 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8246 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8247
8248 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8249 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8250 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8251 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8252 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8253 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8254 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8255 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8256 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8257
8258 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8259 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8260
8261 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8262 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8266 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8270 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8274 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8275 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8276 @end deffn
8277
8278 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8279 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8280 @end deffn
8281
8282 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8283 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8287 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8291 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8295 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8296 @end deffn
8297
8298 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8299 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8300 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8301 and modifying how it is emptied.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8305 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8306 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8307 The image @var{type} may be one of
8308 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8309 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8310 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8314 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8315 @cindex vector_catch
8316 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8317 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8318
8319 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8320 @example
8321 0x01 Trap Reset
8322 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8323 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8324 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8325 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8326 0x20 reserved
8327 0x40 Trap IRQ
8328 0x80 Trap FIQ
8329 @end example
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8333 @cindex vector_table
8334
8335 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8336 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8337 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8338 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8339 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8340
8341 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8342
8343 @end deffn
8344
8345 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8346 @cindex ARMv6
8347
8348 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8349 @cindex ARM11
8350
8351 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8352 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8353 which is enabled by default.
8354 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8355 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8356 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8357 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8358 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8359 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8360 @end deffn
8361
8362 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8363 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8364 which is enabled by default.
8365 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8366 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8370 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8371 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8372 they are disabled by default.
8373 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8374 @end deffn
8375
8376 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8377 @cindex vector_catch
8378 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8379 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8380 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8381
8382 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8383 for certain hardware events.
8384 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8385 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8386 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8390 @cindex ARMv7
8391 @cindex ARMv8
8392
8393 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8394 @cindex Cortex-A
8395
8396 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8397 display information about target caches
8398 @end deffn
8399
8400 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8401 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8402 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8403 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8404 Defaults to 'off'.
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8408 Initialize core debug
8409 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8413 Disable SMP mode
8414 @end deffn
8415
8416 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8417 Enable SMP mode
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8421 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8425 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8426 @end deffn
8427
8428 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8429 configure l2x cache
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432
8433 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8434 @cindex Cortex-R
8435
8436 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8437 Initialize core debug
8438 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8442 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8443 @end deffn
8444
8445
8446 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8447 @cindex tracing
8448 @cindex SWO
8449 @cindex SWV
8450 @cindex TPIU
8451 @cindex ITM
8452 @cindex ETM
8453
8454 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8455 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8456 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8457
8458 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8459 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8460 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8461 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8462
8463 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8464 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8465 debugger adapter features.
8466
8467 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8468 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8469
8470 Command options:
8471 @itemize @minus
8472 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8473 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8474 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8475 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8476 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8477 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8478 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8479 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8480 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8481 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8482 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8483 coding;
8484 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8485 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8486 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8487 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8488 data is to be output via SWO;
8489 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8490 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8491 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8492 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8493 rate automatically.
8494 @end itemize
8495
8496 Example usage:
8497 @enumerate
8498 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8499 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8500 enough to:
8501 @example
8502 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8503 ...
8504 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8505 ...
8506 @end example
8507 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8508 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8509 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8510 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8511 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8512 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8513 @example
8514 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8515 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8516 @end example
8517 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8518 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8519 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8520 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8521 @example
8522 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8523 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8524 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8525 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8526 @end example
8527 @end enumerate
8528 @end deffn
8529
8530 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8531 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8532 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8533 @end deffn
8534
8535 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8536 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8540 @cindex Cortex-M
8541
8542 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8543 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8544
8545 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8546 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8547 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8548 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8549 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8550 the step command leaves with the core running.
8551
8552 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8553 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8554 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8555
8556 Default is @option{auto}.
8557 @end deffn
8558
8559 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8560 @cindex vector_catch
8561 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8562 for certain hardware events.
8563
8564 Parameters request interception of
8565 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8566 @option{none} of them,
8567 or one or more of the following:
8568 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8569 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8570 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8571 @option{irq_err},
8572 @option{state_err},
8573 @option{chk_err}, or
8574 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8575 @option{reset}.
8576 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8577 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8578 are mapped to HardFault.
8579 UsageFault checks for
8580 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8581 must also be explicitly enabled.
8582
8583 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8584 @end deffn
8585
8586 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8587 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8588 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8589 @itemize @minus
8590 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8591 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8592 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8593 @end itemize
8594 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8595 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8596 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8597 the peripherals.
8598 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8602 @cindex ARMv8-A
8603 @cindex aarch64
8604
8605 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8606 Display information about target caches
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8610 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8611 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8612 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8613 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8614 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8618 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8619 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8620 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8621 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8622 @end deffn
8623
8624 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8625 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
8626 @option{on}.
8627 @end deffn
8628
8629 @section Intel Architecture
8630
8631 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8632 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8633 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8634 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8635 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8636 @itemize
8637 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8638 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8639 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8640 @end itemize
8641
8642 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8643 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8644 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8645
8646 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8647 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8648 @end deffn
8649
8650 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8651 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8652 @end deffn
8653
8654 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8655 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8659 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8660 @end deffn
8661
8662 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8663 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8667 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8671
8672 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8673 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8674
8675 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8676 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8677 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8678 @end deffn
8679 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8680 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8681
8682 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8683
8684 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8685 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8686 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @subsection Registers commands
8690 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8691 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8692 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8693
8694 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8695
8696 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8697 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8698 and "timer" groups.
8699
8700 @emph{example:}
8701 @example
8702 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8703 @end example
8704
8705
8706 @end deffn
8707 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8708 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8709
8710 @emph{group} can be "system",
8711 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8712 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8713 @end deffn
8714
8715 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8716 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8717 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8718 @cindex tracing
8719 @cindex libdcc
8720 @cindex DCC
8721 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8722 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8723 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8724 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8725
8726 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8727 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8728 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8729 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8730 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8731 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8732
8733 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8734 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8735 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8736 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8737 The target being debugged may
8738 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8739 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8740 each supported by a command:
8741
8742 @itemize
8743 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8744 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8745 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8746 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8747
8748 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8749 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8750 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8751
8752 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8753 and then displayed at any time.
8754 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8755
8756 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8757 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8758 @end itemize
8759
8760 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8761 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8762 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8763 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8764 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8765 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8766 does the same thing.
8767
8768 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8769 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8770 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8771 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8772 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8773
8774 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8775 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8776 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8777 @end deffn
8778
8779 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8780 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8781 in the order they triggered.
8782 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8783 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8784 history records.
8785 @end deffn
8786
8787 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8788 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8789 they have been triggered.
8790 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8791 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8792 and associates it with that identifier.
8793
8794 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8795 are not related except by this command.
8796 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8797 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800
8801 @node JTAG Commands
8802 @chapter JTAG Commands
8803 @cindex JTAG Commands
8804 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8805 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8806 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8807 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8808 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8809
8810 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8811 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8812
8813 @itemize @bullet
8814 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8815 devices such as a CPUs.
8816 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8817 standard state machine (in parallel)
8818 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8819 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8820 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8821 while the reading previous ones.
8822 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8823 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8824 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8825 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8826 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8827 registers.
8828 @end itemize
8829
8830 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8831
8832 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8833 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8834 the order of TAP state transitions.
8835 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8836 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8837 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8838 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8839 these commands are not available.
8840
8841 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8842 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8843 that specify the entire register.
8844 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8845 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8846 The return value holds the original value of each
8847 of those fields.
8848
8849 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8850 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8851 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8852 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8853 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8854
8855 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8856 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8857
8858 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8859 in that state.
8860 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8861 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8862 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8863
8864 @quotation Warning
8865 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8866 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8867 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8868 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8869 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8870 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8871 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8872 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8873 @end quotation
8874 @end deffn
8875
8876 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8877 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8878 This may be used for performance tuning.
8879
8880 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8881 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8882 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8883 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8884 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8885 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8886 @end deffn
8887
8888 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8889 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8890 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8891 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8892 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8893 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8894
8895 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8896 in that state.
8897 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8898 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8899 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8900
8901 @quotation Note
8902 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8903 register values, unlike data register values.
8904 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8905 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8906 @end quotation
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8910 Set values of reset signals.
8911 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8912 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8913 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8914 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8915 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8916 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8917 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8918
8919 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8920 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8921 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8922 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8923 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8924 instead of the TRST signal.
8925 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8926 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8927 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8928 with handlers for that event.
8929 @end deffn
8930
8931 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8932 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8933 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8934 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8935 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8936 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8937 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8938 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8939 The final state must also be stable.
8940 @end deffn
8941
8942 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8943 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8944 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8945 Instructions often need some time
8946 to execute before they take effect.
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8950 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8951
8952 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8953 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8954 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8955 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8956 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8957 @end deffn
8958
8959 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8960 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8961 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8962 must also be enabled.
8963 Default is enabled.
8964 @end deffn
8965
8966 @section TAP state names
8967 @cindex TAP state names
8968
8969 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8970 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8971 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8972 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8973
8974 @itemize @bullet
8975 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8976 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8977 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8978 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8979 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8980 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8981 through the data register
8982 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8983 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8984 for update or more shifting
8985 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8986 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8987 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8988 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8989 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8990 through the instruction register
8991 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8992 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8993 for update or more shifting
8994 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8995 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8996 @end itemize
8997
8998 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8999 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9000 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9001 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9002
9003 @itemize @bullet
9004 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9005 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9006 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9007 may not be as expected.
9008 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9009 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9010 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9011 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9012 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9013 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9014 @end itemize
9015
9016 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9017 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9018
9019 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9020 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9021 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9022 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9023
9024 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9025 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9026 @cindex SVF
9027
9028 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9029 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9030 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9031 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9032
9033 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9034 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9035 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9036 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9037
9038 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9039 affect their semantics.
9040
9041 Command options:
9042 @itemize @minus
9043 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9044 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9045 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9046 chain configuration, targetting @var{tapname};
9047 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9048 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9049 on the real interface;
9050 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9051 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9052 errors.
9053 @end itemize
9054 @end deffn
9055
9056 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9057 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9058 @cindex XSVF
9059
9060 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9061 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9062 Xilinx devices.
9063 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9064 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9065
9066 @quotation Important
9067 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9068 @end quotation
9069
9070 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9071 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9072 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9073 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9074 that TAP.
9075 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9076 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9077 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9078 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9082 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9083 after building the software.
9084 You may find them useful:
9085
9086 @itemize
9087 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9088 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9089 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9090 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9091 @end itemize
9092
9093 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9094 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9095 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9096 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9097 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9098 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9099 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9100
9101
9102 @node Utility Commands
9103 @chapter Utility Commands
9104 @cindex Utility Commands
9105
9106 @section RAM testing
9107 @cindex RAM testing
9108
9109 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9110 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9111 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9112 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9113 hardware problems.
9114
9115 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9116 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9117 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9118 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9119
9120 Load the memory testing functions with
9121
9122 @example
9123 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9124 @end example
9125
9126 to get access to the following facilities:
9127
9128 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9129 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9130 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9131 @end deffn
9132
9133 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9134 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9135 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9136 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9140 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9141 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9142 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9146 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9150 @cindex Firmware recovery
9151
9152 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9153 devices recovery with JTAG.
9154
9155 For quickstart instructions run:
9156 @example
9157 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9158 @end example
9159
9160 @node TFTP
9161 @chapter TFTP
9162 @cindex TFTP
9163 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9164 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9165
9166 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9167 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9168 server (tftpd). For example,
9169
9170 @example
9171 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9172 @end example
9173
9174 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9175 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9176
9177 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9178 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9179 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9180 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9181
9182 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9183 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9184 @cindex GDB
9185 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9186 to debug remote targets.
9187 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9188
9189 @itemize
9190 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9191 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9192 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9193 as shown in this chapter.
9194 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9195 that also will probably need to be configured.
9196 @end itemize
9197
9198 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9199 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9200 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9201 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9202 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9203 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9204
9205 @section Connecting to GDB
9206 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9207 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9208 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9209 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9210 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9211
9212 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9213
9214 @enumerate
9215 @item
9216 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9217 @example
9218 target remote localhost:3333
9219 @end example
9220 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9221
9222 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9223 @example
9224 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9225 @end example
9226 @item
9227 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9228 @example
9229 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9230 @end example
9231 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9232 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9233 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9234 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9235 @end enumerate
9236
9237 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9238 GDB command line.
9239
9240 @section Sample GDB session startup
9241
9242 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9243 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9244 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9245 small ARM program.
9246 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9247 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9248
9249 @example
9250 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9251 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9252 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9253 ...
9254 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9255 ...
9256 (gdb) load
9257 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9258 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9259 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9260 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9261 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9262 (gdb) continue
9263 Continuing.
9264 ...
9265 @end example
9266
9267 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9268 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9269 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9270 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9271
9272 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9273
9274 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9275 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9276 packet size and the device's memory map.
9277 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9278 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9279 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9280
9281 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9282 You may need to set those up by hand.
9283 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9284 something like:
9285
9286 @example
9287 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9288 @end example
9289
9290 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9291
9292 @example
9293 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9294 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9295 @end example
9296
9297 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9298 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9299 do not have such restrictions.
9300
9301 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9302 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9303 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9304 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9305
9306 @section Programming using GDB
9307 @cindex Programming using GDB
9308 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9309
9310 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9311 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9312 @example
9313 gdb_memory_map disable
9314 @end example
9315 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9316 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9317 working area.
9318
9319 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9320 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9321 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9322 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9323
9324 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9325 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9326
9327 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9328 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9329 @example
9330 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9331 @end example
9332
9333 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9334 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9335
9336 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9337 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9338 will be used.
9339
9340 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
9341 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
9342 @example
9343 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
9344 @end example
9345 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
9346
9347 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9348 can be used.
9349
9350 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9351 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9352 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
9353
9354 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
9355 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
9356 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
9357
9358 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
9359 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
9360 and GDB treats it as it were running.
9361 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
9362 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
9363 without any intrusion of the target process.
9364
9365 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9366 Place following command after target configuration:
9367 @example
9368 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
9369 @end example
9370
9371 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
9372 switch off gdb_memory_map:
9373 @example
9374 gdb_memory_map disable
9375 @end example
9376
9377 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
9378 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
9379 @example
9380 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
9381 @end example
9382
9383 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
9384 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
9385
9386 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
9387 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
9388 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
9389 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
9390
9391 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
9392 previously shown varibles.
9393
9394 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9395 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9396 @cindex SMP
9397 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9398 @itemize @bullet
9399 @item j - smp status request
9400 @item J - smp set request
9401 @end itemize
9402
9403 OpenOCD implements :
9404 @itemize @bullet
9405 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9406 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9407 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9408 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9409 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9410 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9411 @end itemize
9412
9413 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9414 @itemize @bullet
9415 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9416 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9417 @example
9418 set $_core 1
9419 #Jc01 packet is sent
9420 print $_core
9421 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9422 @end example
9423
9424 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9425 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9426
9427 @example
9428 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9429 define toggle0
9430 maint packet Jc0
9431 continue
9432 main packet Jc-1
9433 end
9434 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9435 define toggle1
9436 maint packet Jc1
9437 continue
9438 main packet Jc-1
9439 end
9440 @end example
9441 @end itemize
9442
9443 @section RTOS Support
9444 @cindex RTOS Support
9445 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9446
9447 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9448 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9449
9450 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9451 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9452 GDB commands.
9453
9454 @* An example setup is below:
9455
9456 @example
9457 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9458 @end example
9459
9460 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9461
9462 Currently supported rtos's include:
9463 @itemize @bullet
9464 @item @option{eCos}
9465 @item @option{ThreadX}
9466 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9467 @item @option{linux}
9468 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9469 @item @option{embKernel}
9470 @item @option{mqx}
9471 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9472 @end itemize
9473
9474 @quotation Note
9475 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9476 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9477 @end quotation
9478
9479 @table @code
9480 @item eCos symbols
9481 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9482 @item ThreadX symbols
9483 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9484 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9485 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9486 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9487 @tex
9488 \begingroup
9489 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9490 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9491 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9492 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9493 \par
9494 \endgroup
9495 @end tex
9496 @item linux symbols
9497 init_task.
9498 @item ChibiOS symbols
9499 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9500 @item embKernel symbols
9501 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9502 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9503 @item mqx symbols
9504 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9505 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9506 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9507 @end table
9508
9509 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9510 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9511
9512 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9513 along with the project:
9514
9515 @table @code
9516 @item FreeRTOS
9517 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9518 @item uC/OS-III
9519 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9520 @end table
9521
9522 @node Tcl Scripting API
9523 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9524 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9525 @cindex Tcl scripts
9526 @section API rules
9527
9528 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9529 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9530 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9531
9532 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9533 pair list and lists.
9534
9535 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9536 list.
9537
9538 @example
9539 > set foo(me) Duane
9540 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9541 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9542 > set foo(duck) Donald
9543 @end example
9544
9545 If one does this:
9546
9547 @example
9548 > set foo
9549 @end example
9550
9551 The result is:
9552
9553 @example
9554 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9555 @end example
9556
9557 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9558
9559 @verbatim
9560 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9561 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9562 }
9563 @end verbatim
9564
9565 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9566 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9567
9568 @section Internal low-level Commands
9569
9570 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9571 invoke directly.
9572
9573 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9574 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9575 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9576
9577 @itemize @bullet
9578 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9579
9580 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9581 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9582
9583 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9584 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9585
9586 Return information about the flash banks
9587
9588 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9589
9590 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9591 its execution. Example:
9592
9593 @example
9594 > capture "reset init"
9595 @end example
9596
9597 @end itemize
9598
9599 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9600 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9601 called "flash_banks".
9602
9603 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9604
9605 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9606 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9607 holds one of the following values:
9608
9609 @itemize @bullet
9610 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9611 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9612 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9613 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9614 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9615 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9616 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9617 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9618 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9619 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9620 @end itemize
9621
9622 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9623
9624 @quotation Note
9625 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9626 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9627 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9628 is jim, not real tcl).
9629 @end quotation
9630
9631 @section Tcl RPC server
9632 @cindex RPC
9633
9634 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9635 commands and receive the results.
9636
9637 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9638 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9639 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9640 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9641 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9642
9643 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9644 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9645 @command{capture} command.
9646
9647 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9648
9649 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9650 @cindex RPC Notifications
9651
9652 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9653 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9654
9655 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9656 in the following format.
9657
9658 @verbatim
9659 type target_event event [event-name]
9660 type target_state state [state-name]
9661 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9662 @end verbatim
9663
9664 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9665 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9666 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9667 Defaults to off.
9668
9669 @end deffn
9670
9671 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9672 @cindex RPC trace output
9673
9674 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9675 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9676
9677 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9678
9679 @verbatim
9680 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9681 @end verbatim
9682
9683 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9684 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9685 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9686 Defaults to off.
9687
9688 See an example application here:
9689 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9690
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @node FAQ
9694 @chapter FAQ
9695 @cindex faq
9696 @enumerate
9697 @anchor{faqrtck}
9698 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9699 @cindex RTCK
9700 @cindex adaptive clocking
9701 @*
9702
9703 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9704 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9705 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9706 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9707
9708 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9709 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9710 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9711 @enumerate
9712 @item
9713 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9714 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9715 @item
9716 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9717 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9718 @end enumerate
9719
9720 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9721 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9722 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9723 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9724 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9725 power).
9726
9727 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9728 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9729 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9730 ARM926 scenario).
9731 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9732 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9733 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9734
9735 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9736 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9737 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9738 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9739
9740 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9741
9742 In order to make use of this,
9743 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9744 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9745
9746 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9747 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9748 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9749 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9750 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9751
9752 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9753 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9754 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9755 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9756
9757 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9758 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9759 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9760 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9761 with a CPLD.
9762 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9763 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9764 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9765 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9766 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9767 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9768
9769 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9770
9771 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9772
9773 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9774 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9775 depending on the chips on your board.
9776 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9777 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9778 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9779
9780 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9781 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9782 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9783
9784 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9785 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9786 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9787 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9788
9789 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9790 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9791 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9792 this way.
9793
9794 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9795 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9796 clock rate.
9797 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9798 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9799 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9800
9801 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9802
9803 @example
9804 # Example: 1.234MHz
9805 adapter_khz 1234
9806 @end example
9807
9808
9809 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9810
9811 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9812 around Windows filenames.
9813
9814 @example
9815 > echo \a
9816
9817 > echo @{\a@}
9818 \a
9819 > echo "\a"
9820
9821 >
9822 @end example
9823
9824
9825 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9826
9827 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9828 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9829 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9830
9831 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9832 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9833 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9834
9835 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9836 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9837 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9838
9839 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9840
9841 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9842 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9843 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9844 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9845
9846 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9847 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9848 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9849
9850 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9851 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9852
9853 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9854 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9855 memory read caused data abort".
9856
9857 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9858 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9859 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9860 be done, feel free to add this here.
9861
9862 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9863 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9864 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9865 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9866 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9867 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9868 gracefully stops.
9869
9870 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9871 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9872 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9873
9874 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9875 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9876 bytes. Painful...
9877
9878
9879 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9880 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9881
9882 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9883 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9884 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9885 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9886 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9887 reset, everything else should work fine.
9888
9889 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9890 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9891 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9892 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9893
9894 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9895 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9896 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9897 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9898
9899 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9900
9901 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9902 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9903 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9904
9905 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9906 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9907
9908 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9909 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9910 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9911 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9912 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9913 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9914 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9915 clock frequency?
9916
9917 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9918 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9919 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9920 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9921 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9922
9923 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9924
9925 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9926 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9927 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9928 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9929 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9930 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9931 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9932
9933 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9934
9935 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9936 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9937 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9938 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9939
9940 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9941 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9942 particular order?
9943
9944 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9945 the same order used by the hardware.
9946
9947 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9948 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9949 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9950 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9951 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9952 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9953
9954 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9955 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9956 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9957 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9958
9959 @itemize @bullet
9960 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9961 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9962 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9963 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9964 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9965 @end itemize
9966
9967 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9968
9969 @itemize @bullet
9970 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9971 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9972 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9973 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9974 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9975 @end itemize
9976
9977
9978 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9979 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9980 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9981
9982 TODO.
9983
9984 @end enumerate
9985
9986 @node Tcl Crash Course
9987 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9988 @cindex Tcl
9989
9990 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9991 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9992 how the Tcl scripts work.
9993
9994 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9995 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9996 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9997 OpenOCD.
9998
9999 @section Tcl Rule #1
10000 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10001 @enumerate
10002 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10003 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10004 @end enumerate
10005
10006 The Tcl equal is this:
10007
10008 @enumerate
10009 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10010 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10011 @end enumerate
10012
10013 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10014 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10015
10016 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10017 There is a second pair of rules.
10018 @enumerate
10019 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10020 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10021 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10022 in Tcl.
10023 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10024 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10025 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10026 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10027 @end enumerate
10028
10029 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10030 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10031 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10032 Everything is a string}
10033
10034 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10035 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10036 difference is subtle.
10037 @enumerate
10038 @item Parse Time
10039 @item Evaluation Time
10040 @end enumerate
10041
10042 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10043 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10044 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10045
10046 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10047 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10048 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
10049 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10050
10051 @itemize @bullet
10052 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10053 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10054 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10055 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10056 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10057 @example
10058 # bash example
10059 X=`date`
10060 echo "The Date is: $X"
10061 # Tcl example
10062 set X [date]
10063 puts "The Date is: $X"
10064 @end example
10065 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10066 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10067 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10068 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10069 is a string}
10070 @example
10071 set x "Dinner"
10072 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10073 @end example
10074 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10075 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10076 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10077 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10078 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10079 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10080 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10081 @end itemize
10082
10083 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10084
10085 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10086
10087 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10088
10089 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10090 the normal way.
10091
10092 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10093 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10094 line is immedatly executed.
10095
10096 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10097 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10098
10099 @subsection Command Execution
10100
10101 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10102 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10103 control flow operators.
10104
10105 Commands are executed like this:
10106
10107 @enumerate
10108 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10109 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10110 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10111 @end enumerate
10112
10113 It sort of works like this:
10114 @example
10115 for(;;)@{
10116 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10117
10118 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10119
10120 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10121 @}
10122 @end example
10123
10124 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10125 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10126 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10127 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10128 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10129 ``LookupCommand()''
10130
10131 @subsection The FOR command
10132
10133 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10134 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10135 command just like any other command.
10136
10137 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10138 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10139 are:
10140
10141 @enumerate 0
10142 @item The ascii text 'for'
10143 @item The start text
10144 @item The test expression
10145 @item The next text
10146 @item The body text
10147 @end enumerate
10148
10149 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10150 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10151 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10152 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10153
10154 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10155 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10156
10157 @example
10158 int
10159 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10160 int *argc,
10161 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10162 @end example
10163
10164 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10165 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
10166 still operates in the same basic way.
10167
10168 @subsection FOR command implementation
10169
10170 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10171 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10172
10173 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10174
10175 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10176
10177 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10178 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10179 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10180
10181 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10182 expression and returns a value.
10183
10184 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10185 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10186 @example
10187 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10188
10189 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10190
10191 int
10192 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10193 int argc,
10194 char **argv )
10195 @{
10196 if( argc != 5 )@{
10197 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10198 return ERROR;
10199 @}
10200
10201 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10202
10203 // Execute the start statement.
10204 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10205
10206 // Top of loop test
10207 for(;;)@{
10208 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10209 if( i == 0 )
10210 break;
10211
10212 // Execute the body
10213 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10214
10215 // Execute the LOOP part
10216 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10217 @}
10218
10219 // Return no error
10220 SetResult( interp, "" );
10221 return SUCCESS;
10222 @}
10223 @end example
10224
10225 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10226 in the same basic way.
10227
10228 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10229
10230 @subsection source and find commands
10231 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10232 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10233 @*Remember the parsing rules
10234 @enumerate
10235 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10236 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10237 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10238 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10239 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10240 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10241 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10242 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10243 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10244 @end enumerate
10245 @subsection format command
10246 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10247 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10248 @b{sprintf()}.
10249 @b{Example}
10250 @example
10251 set x 6
10252 set y 7
10253 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10254 @end example
10255 @enumerate
10256 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10257 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10258 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10259 @* Refer to Rule #1
10260 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10261 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10262 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10263 @end enumerate
10264 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10265 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10266 @example
10267 #1 Good
10268 proc someproc @{@} @{
10269 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10270 @}
10271 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10272 #2 Good - no variables
10273 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
10274 #3 Good Curly Braces
10275 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10276 puts "Time: [date]"
10277 @}
10278 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10279 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10280 @end example
10281 @enumerate
10282 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10283 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10284 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10285 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10286 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10287 command.
10288 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10289 @*There are 4 examples:
10290 @enumerate
10291 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10292 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
10293 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10294 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10295 @end enumerate
10296
10297 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10298 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10299 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10300
10301 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10302 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10303 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10304 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10305 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10306 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10307 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10308 @end enumerate
10309 @subsection Global Variables
10310 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10311 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10312 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10313 @example
10314 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10315 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10316 global x #Global variable X
10317 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10318 @}
10319 @end example
10320 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10321 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10322 @example
10323 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10324 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10325 # Create var name
10326 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10327 # Make it a global
10328 global $vn
10329 # Set it.
10330 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10331 @}
10332 @end example
10333 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10334 @example
10335 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10336 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10337 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10338 @}
10339 @end example
10340
10341 @include fdl.texi
10342
10343 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10344 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10345 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10346 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10347 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10348 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10349
10350 @printindex cp
10351
10352 @node Command and Driver Index
10353 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10354 @printindex fn
10355
10356 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)